]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/org.texi
b5e93d74fdbad6f62ee39bd6ded7b60ed6a690df
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5 @set VERSION 7.9.2 (GNU Emacs 24.3)
6
7 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
8 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
9 @set txicodequoteundirected
10 @set txicodequotebacktick
11
12 @c Version and Contact Info
13 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
14 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
15 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
16 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
17 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
18 @c %**end of header
19 @finalout
20
21
22 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
23
24 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
25 @c =======================================
26
27 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
28 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
29
30 @set cmdnames
31
32 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
33
34 @c orgkey{key} A key item
35 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
36 @c xorgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name as @itemx
37 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
38 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
39 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
40 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
41 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
42 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
43 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
44 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
45
46 @c a key but no command
47 @c Inserts: @item key
48 @macro orgkey{key}
49 @kindex \key\
50 @item @kbd{\key\}
51 @end macro
52
53 @macro xorgkey{key}
54 @kindex \key\
55 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
56 @end macro
57
58 @c one key with a command
59 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
60 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
61 @ifset cmdnames
62 @kindex \key\
63 @findex \command\
64 @iftex
65 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
66 @end iftex
67 @ifnottex
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
69 @end ifnottex
70 @end ifset
71 @ifclear cmdnames
72 @kindex \key\
73 @item @kbd{\key\}
74 @end ifclear
75 @end macro
76
77 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
78 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
79 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
80 @ifset cmdnames
81 @kindex \key\
82 @findex \command\
83 @iftex
84 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
85 @end iftex
86 @ifnottex
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
88 @end ifnottex
89 @end ifset
90 @ifclear cmdnames
91 @kindex \key\
92 @itemx @kbd{\key\}
93 @end ifclear
94 @end macro
95
96 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
97 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
98 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
99 @ifset cmdnames
100 @findex \command\
101 @iftex
102 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
103 @end iftex
104 @ifnottex
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
106 @end ifnottex
107 @end ifset
108 @ifclear cmdnames
109 @item @kbd{\key\}
110 @end ifclear
111 @end macro
112
113 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
114 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
115 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
116 @ifset cmdnames
117 @kindex \key\
118 @findex \command\
119 @iftex
120 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
121 @end iftex
122 @ifnottex
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
124 @end ifnottex
125 @end ifset
126 @ifclear cmdnames
127 @kindex \key\
128 @item @kbd{\text\}
129 @end ifclear
130 @end macro
131
132 @c two keys with one command
133 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
134 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
135 @ifset cmdnames
136 @kindex \key1\
137 @kindex \key2\
138 @findex \command\
139 @iftex
140 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
141 @end iftex
142 @ifnottex
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
144 @end ifnottex
145 @end ifset
146 @ifclear cmdnames
147 @kindex \key1\
148 @kindex \key2\
149 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
150 @end ifclear
151 @end macro
152
153 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
154 @c @itemx
155 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
156 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
157 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
158 @ifset cmdnames
159 @kindex \key1\
160 @kindex \key2\
161 @findex \command\
162 @iftex
163 @item @kbd{\key1\}
164 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
165 @end iftex
166 @ifnottex
167 @item @kbd{\key1\}
168 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
169 @end ifnottex
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear cmdnames
172 @kindex \key1\
173 @kindex \key2\
174 @item @kbd{\key1\}
175 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
176 @end ifclear
177 @end macro
178
179 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
180 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
181 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
182 @ifset cmdnames
183 @kindex \key1\
184 @kindex \key2\
185 @findex \command\
186 @iftex
187 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
188 @end iftex
189 @ifnottex
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
191 @end ifnottex
192 @end ifset
193 @ifclear cmdnames
194 @kindex \key1\
195 @kindex \key2\
196 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
197 @end ifclear
198 @end macro
199
200 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
201 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
202 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
203 @ifset cmdnames
204 @kindex \key1\
205 @kindex \key2\
206 @findex \command\
207 @iftex
208 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
209 @end iftex
210 @ifnottex
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
212 @end ifnottex
213 @end ifset
214 @ifclear cmdnames
215 @kindex \key1\
216 @kindex \key2\
217 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
218 @end ifclear
219 @end macro
220
221 @c two keys with two commands
222 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
223 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
224 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
225 @ifset cmdnames
226 @kindex \key1\
227 @kindex \key2\
228 @findex \command1\
229 @findex \command2\
230 @iftex
231 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
232 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
233 @end iftex
234 @ifnottex
235 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
236 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
237 @end ifnottex
238 @end ifset
239 @ifclear cmdnames
240 @kindex \key1\
241 @kindex \key2\
242 @item @kbd{\key1\}
243 @itemx @kbd{\key2\}
244 @end ifclear
245 @end macro
246 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
247
248 @iftex
249 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
250 @end iftex
251
252 @c Subheadings inside a table.
253 @macro tsubheading{text}
254 @ifinfo
255 @subsubheading \text\
256 @end ifinfo
257 @ifnotinfo
258 @item @b{\text\}
259 @end ifnotinfo
260 @end macro
261
262 @copying
263 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
264
265 Copyright @copyright{} 2004--2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
266
267 @quotation
268 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
269 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
270 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
271 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
272 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
273 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
274
275 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
276 modify this GNU manual.''
277 @end quotation
278 @end copying
279
280 @dircategory Emacs editing modes
281 @direntry
282 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
283 @end direntry
284
285 @titlepage
286 @title The Org Manual
287
288 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
289 @author by Carsten Dominik
290 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, Thomas Dye and Jambunathan K.
291
292 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
293 @page
294 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
295 @insertcopying
296 @end titlepage
297
298 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
299 @contents
300
301 @ifnottex
302 @c FIXME These hand-written next,prev,up node pointers make editing a lot
303 @c harder. There should be no need for them, makeinfo can do it
304 @c automatically for any document with a normal structure.
305 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
306 @top Org Mode Manual
307
308 @insertcopying
309 @end ifnottex
310
311 @menu
312 * Introduction:: Getting started
313 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
314 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
315 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
316 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
317 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
318 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
319 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
320 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
321 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
322 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
323 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
324 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
325 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
326 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
327 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
328 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
329 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
330 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
331 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
332 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
333 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
334 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
335
336 @detailmenu
337 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
338
339 Introduction
340
341 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
342 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
343 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
344 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
345 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
346
347 Document structure
348
349 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
350 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
351 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
352 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
353 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
354 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
355 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
356 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
357 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
358 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
359 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
360
361 Tables
362
363 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
364 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
365 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
366 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
367 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
368 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
369
370 The spreadsheet
371
372 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
373 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
374 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
375 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
376 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
377 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
378 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
379 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
380 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
381
382 Hyperlinks
383
384 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
385 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
386 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
387 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
388 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
389 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
390 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
391 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
392
393 Internal links
394
395 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
396
397 TODO items
398
399 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
400 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
401 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
402 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
403 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
404 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
405
406 Extended use of TODO keywords
407
408 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
409 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
410 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
411 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
412 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
413 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
414 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
415
416 Progress logging
417
418 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
419 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
420 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
421
422 Tags
423
424 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
425 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
426 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
427
428 Properties and columns
429
430 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
431 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
432 * Property searches:: Matching property values
433 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
434 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
435 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
436
437 Column view
438
439 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
440 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
441 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
442
443 Defining columns
444
445 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
446 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
447
448 Dates and times
449
450 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
451 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
452 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
453 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
454 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
455 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
456 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
457
458 Creating timestamps
459
460 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
461 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
462
463 Deadlines and scheduling
464
465 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
466 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
467
468 Clocking work time
469
470 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
471 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
472 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
473
474 Capture - Refile - Archive
475
476 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
477 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
478 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
479 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
480 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
481 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
482
483 Capture
484
485 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
486 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
487 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
488
489 Capture templates
490
491 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
492 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
493 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
494
495 Archiving
496
497 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
498 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
499
500 Agenda views
501
502 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
503 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
504 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
505 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
506 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
507 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
508 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
509 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
510
511 The built-in agenda views
512
513 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
514 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
515 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
516 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
517 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
518 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
519
520 Presentation and sorting
521
522 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
523 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
524 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
525
526 Custom agenda views
527
528 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
529 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
530 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
531
532 Markup for rich export
533
534 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
535 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
536 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
537 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
538 * Index entries:: Making an index
539 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
540 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
541
542 Structural markup elements
543
544 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
545 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
546 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
547 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
548 * Lists:: Lists
549 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
550 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
551 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
552 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
553 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
554
555 Embedded @LaTeX{}
556
557 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
558 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
559 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
560 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
561 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
562
563 Exporting
564
565 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
566 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
567 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
568 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
569 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
570 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
571 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
572 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
573 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
574 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
575 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
576 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
577
578 HTML export
579
580 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
581 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
582 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
583 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
584 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
585 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
586 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
587 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
588 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
589 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
590
591 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
592
593 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
594 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
595 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
596 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
597 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
598 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
599
600 DocBook export
601
602 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
603 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
604 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
605 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
606 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
607 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
608
609 OpenDocument Text export
610
611 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
612 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
613 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
614 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
615 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
616 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
617 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
618 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
619 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
620 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
621 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
622
623 Math formatting in ODT export
624
625 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
626 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
627
628 Advanced topics in ODT export
629
630 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
631 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
632 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
633 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
634 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
635
636 Publishing
637
638 * Configuration:: Defining projects
639 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
640 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
641 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
642
643 Configuration
644
645 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
646 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
647 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
648 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
649 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
650 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
651 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
652 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
653
654 Sample configuration
655
656 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
657 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
658
659 Working with source code
660
661 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
662 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
663 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
664 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
665 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
666 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
667 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
668 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
669 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
670 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
671 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
672 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
673
674 Header arguments
675
676 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
677 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
678
679 Using header arguments
680
681 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
682 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
683 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
684 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
685 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
686 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
687
688 Specific header arguments
689
690 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
691 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
692 be collected and handled
693 * file:: Specify a path for file output
694 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
695 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
696 directory for code block execution
697 * exports:: Export code and/or results
698 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
699 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
700 files during tangling
701 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
702 code files
703 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
704 code files
705 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
706 expansion during tangling
707 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
708 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
709 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
710 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
711 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
712 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
713 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
714 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
715 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
716 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
717 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
718 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
719
720 Miscellaneous
721
722 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
723 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
724 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
725 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
726 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
727 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
728 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
729 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
730 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
731 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
732 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
733
734 Interaction with other packages
735
736 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
737 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
738
739 Hacking
740
741 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
742 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
743 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
744 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
745 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
746 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
747 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
748 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
749 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
750 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
751
752 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
753
754 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
755 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
756 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
757 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
758
759 MobileOrg
760
761 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
762 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
763 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
764
765 @end detailmenu
766 @end menu
767
768 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
769 @chapter Introduction
770 @cindex introduction
771
772 @menu
773 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
774 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
775 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
776 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
777 * Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual
778 @end menu
779
780 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
781 @section Summary
782 @cindex summary
783
784 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
785 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
786
787 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
788 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
789 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
790 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
791 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
792 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
793 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
794 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
795 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
796 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
797 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
798 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
799 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
800 linked web pages.
801
802 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
803 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
804 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
805
806 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
807 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
808 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
809
810 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
811 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
812 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
813 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
814 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
815 the minor Orgstruct mode.
816
817 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
818 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
819 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
820 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
821 ends, for example:
822
823 @example
824 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
825 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
826 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
827 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
828 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
829 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
830 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
831 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
832 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
833 @end example
834
835 @cindex FAQ
836 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
837 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
838 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at
839 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
840
841 @cindex print edition
842 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
843 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
844 Theory Ltd.}
845
846 @page
847
848
849 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
850 @section Installation
851 @cindex installation
852 @cindex XEmacs
853
854 @b{Important:} @i{If you the version of Org that comes with Emacs or as a
855 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to @ref{Activation}.
856 If you downloaded Org as an ELPA package, please read the instructions on the
857 @uref{http://orgmode.org/elpa.html, Org ELPA page}. To see what version of Org
858 (if any) is part of your Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x org-version} (if
859 your Emacs distribution does not come with Org, this function will not be
860 defined).}
861
862 Installation of Org mode uses a build system, which is described in more
863 detail on @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html, Worg}.
864
865 If you have downloaded Org from the Web as a distribution @file{.zip} or
866 @file{.tar.gz} archive, take the following steps to install it:
867
868 @itemize @bullet
869 @item Unpack the distribution archive.
870 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org directory.
871 @item Run @code{make help config}
872 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk} if the default configuration
873 does not match your system. Set the name of the Emacs binary (likely either
874 @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the directories where local
875 Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the Emacs binary is not in your
876 path, give the full path to the executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
877 @item Run @code{make config}
878 again to check the configuration.
879 @item Run @code{make install} or @code{sudo make install}
880 to build and install Org mode on your system.
881 @end itemize
882
883 If you use a cloned Git repository, then the procedure is slightly different.
884 The following description assumes that you are using the @code{master} branch
885 (where the development is done). You could also use the @code{maint} branch
886 instead, where the release versions are published, just replace @code{master}
887 with @code{maint} in the description below.
888
889 @itemize @bullet
890 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
891 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
892 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
893 @item Run @code{make help}
894 and then check and edit the file @file{local.mk}. You must set the name of
895 the Emacs binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths
896 to the directories where local Lisp and Info files will be installed. If the
897 Emacs binary is not in your path, you must give the full path to the
898 executable. Avoid spaces in any path names.
899 @item Run @code{make config}
900 to check the configuration.
901 @item Optionally run @code{make test}
902 to build Org mode and then run the full testsuite.
903 @item Run @code{make update2} or @code{make up2}
904 to update the Git repository and build and install Org mode. The latter
905 invocation runs the complete test suite before installation and installs only
906 if the build passes all tests.
907 @end itemize
908
909 If you don't have access to the system-wide directories and you don't want to
910 install somewhere into your home directory, you can run Org directly from the
911 distribution directory or Org repository by compiling Org mode in place:
912
913 @itemize @bullet
914 @item Change into (@code{cd}) the Org repository.
915 @item Run @code{git checkout master}
916 to switch to the @code{master} branch of the Org repository.
917 @item Run @code{make compile}
918 @end itemize
919
920 Last but not least you can also run Org mode directly from an Org repository
921 without any compilation. Simply replace the last step in the recipe above
922 with @code{make uncompiled}.
923
924 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
925
926 @example
927 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp")
928 @end example
929
930 @noindent
931 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory without
932 compiling them, do a similar step for this directory:
933
934 @example
935 (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t)
936 @end example
937
938 If you want to include those files with the build and install, please
939 customize the variable @code{ORG_ADD_CONTRIB} instead in your @code{local.mk}
940 file, for more details please see this
941 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html#sec-4-1-2,
942 description on Worg}.
943
944 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
945 @file{install-info} program. The Info documentation is installed together
946 with the rest of Org mode. If you don't install Org mode, it is possible to
947 install the Info documentation separately (you need to have
948 install-info@footnote{The output from install-info (if any) is system
949 dependent. In particular Debian and its derivatives use two different
950 versions of install-info and you may see the message:
951
952 @example
953 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
954 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
955 @end example
956
957 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}
958 on your system).
959
960 @example
961 make install-info
962 @end example
963
964 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
965 @page
966
967 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
968 @section Activation
969 @cindex activation
970 @cindex autoload
971 @cindex ELPA
972 @cindex global key bindings
973 @cindex key bindings, global
974 @findex org-agenda
975 @findex org-capture
976 @findex org-store-link
977 @findex org-iswitchb
978
979 Since Emacs 22.2, files with the @file{.org} extension use Org mode by
980 default. If you are using an earlier version of Emacs, add this line to your
981 @file{.emacs} file:
982
983 @lisp
984 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
985 @end lisp
986
987 Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in
988 Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer
989 with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
990
991 There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp
992 packages, please take the time to check the list (@pxref{Conflicts}).
993
994 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
995 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
996 global keys (i.e., anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
997 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
998 liking.
999 @lisp
1000 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
1001 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
1002 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
1003 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
1004 @end lisp
1005
1006 @cindex Org mode, turning on
1007 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
1008 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
1009 like this:
1010
1011 @example
1012 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
1013 @end example
1014
1015 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
1016 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
1017 the file's name is. See also the variable
1018 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
1019
1020 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
1021 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
1022 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
1023 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
1024 @lisp
1025 (transient-mark-mode 1)
1026 @end lisp
1027 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
1028 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
1029 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
1030
1031 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
1032 @section Feedback
1033 @cindex feedback
1034 @cindex bug reports
1035 @cindex maintainer
1036 @cindex author
1037
1038 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
1039 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
1040 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
1041 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
1042 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
1043 moderators have to do.}.
1044
1045 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
1046 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
1047 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
1048 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
1049 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
1050 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
1051 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
1052 @example
1053 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
1054 @end example
1055 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
1056 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
1057 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
1058
1059 Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or Org mode
1060 setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start Emacs with minimal
1061 customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so often helps you determine
1062 if the problem is with your customization or with Org mode itself. You can
1063 start a typical minimal session with a command like the example below.
1064
1065 @example
1066 $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el
1067 @end example
1068
1069 However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a minimal setup
1070 is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start Emacs as
1071 @code{emacs -Q}. The @code{minimal-org.el} setup file can have contents as
1072 shown below.
1073
1074 @example
1075 ;;; Minimal setup to load latest `org-mode'
1076
1077 ;; activate debugging
1078 (setq debug-on-error t
1079 debug-on-signal nil
1080 debug-on-quit nil)
1081
1082 ;; add latest org-mode to load path
1083 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/lisp"))
1084 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t))
1085 @end example
1086
1087 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
1088 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
1089 about:
1090
1091 @enumerate
1092 @item What exactly did you do?
1093 @item What did you expect to happen?
1094 @item What happened instead?
1095 @end enumerate
1096 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1097
1098 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1099
1100 @cindex backtrace of an error
1101 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1102 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1103 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1104 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1105 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1106
1107 @enumerate
1108 @item
1109 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1110 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1111 To do this, use
1112 @example
1113 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1114 @end example
1115 @noindent
1116 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1117 menu.
1118 @item
1119 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1120 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1121 @item
1122 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1123 document the steps you take.
1124 @item
1125 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1126 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1127 attach it to your bug report.
1128 @end enumerate
1129
1130 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1131 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1132
1133 @subsubheading TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc.
1134
1135 Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and property
1136 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1137
1138 @table @code
1139 @item TODO
1140 @itemx WAITING
1141 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1142 user-defined.
1143 @item boss
1144 @itemx ARCHIVE
1145 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1146 meaning are written with all capitals.
1147 @item Release
1148 @itemx PRIORITY
1149 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1150 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1151 @end table
1152
1153 Moreover, Org uses @i{option keywords} (like @code{#+TITLE} to set the title)
1154 and @i{environment keywords} (like @code{#+BEGIN_HTML} to start a @code{HTML}
1155 environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance its
1156 readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org files@footnote{Easy
1157 templates insert lowercase keywords and Babel dynamically inserts
1158 @code{#+results}.}
1159
1160 @subsubheading Keybindings and commands
1161 @kindex C-c a
1162 @findex org-agenda
1163 @kindex C-c c
1164 @findex org-capture
1165
1166 The manual suggests two global keybindings: @kbd{C-c a} for @code{org-agenda}
1167 and @kbd{C-c c} for @code{org-capture}. These are only suggestions, but the
1168 rest of the manual assumes that you are using these keybindings.
1169
1170 Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for
1171 accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different
1172 functions, depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has
1173 a generic name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever
1174 possible, give the function that is internally called by the generic command.
1175 For example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will
1176 be listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it
1177 will be listed to call @code{org-table-move-column-right}. If you prefer,
1178 you can compile the manual without the command names by unsetting the flag
1179 @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1180
1181 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1182 @chapter Document structure
1183 @cindex document structure
1184 @cindex structure of document
1185
1186 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1187 edit the structure of the document.
1188
1189 @menu
1190 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1191 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1192 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1193 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1194 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1195 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1196 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1197 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1198 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1199 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1200 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1201 @end menu
1202
1203 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1204 @section Outlines
1205 @cindex outlines
1206 @cindex Outline mode
1207
1208 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1209 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1210 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1211 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1212 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1213 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1214 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1215 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1216
1217 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1218 @section Headlines
1219 @cindex headlines
1220 @cindex outline tree
1221 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1222 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1223 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1224
1225 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1226 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1227 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1228 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1229 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.} @footnote{Clocking only works with
1230 headings indented less then 30 stars.}. For example:
1231
1232 @example
1233 * Top level headline
1234 ** Second level
1235 *** 3rd level
1236 some text
1237 *** 3rd level
1238 more text
1239
1240 * Another top level headline
1241 @end example
1242
1243 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1244 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1245 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1246
1247 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1248 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1249 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1250 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1251 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1252 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1253
1254 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1255 @section Visibility cycling
1256 @cindex cycling, visibility
1257 @cindex visibility cycling
1258 @cindex trees, visibility
1259 @cindex show hidden text
1260 @cindex hide text
1261
1262 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1263 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1264 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1265
1266 @cindex subtree visibility states
1267 @cindex subtree cycling
1268 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1269 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1270 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1271 @table @asis
1272 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1273 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1274
1275 @example
1276 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1277 '-----------------------------------'
1278 @end example
1279
1280 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1281 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1282 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1283 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1284 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1285 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1286 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1287 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1288
1289 @cindex global visibility states
1290 @cindex global cycling
1291 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1292 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1293 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1294 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1295 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1296 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1297
1298 @example
1299 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1300 '--------------------------------------'
1301 @end example
1302
1303 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1304 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1305 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1306
1307 @cindex show all, command
1308 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1309 Show all, including drawers.
1310 @cindex revealing context
1311 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1312 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1313 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1314 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1315 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1316 level, all sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the
1317 entire subtree of the parent.
1318 @cindex show branches, command
1319 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1320 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1321 @cindex show children, command
1322 @orgcmd{C-c @key{TAB},show-children}
1323 Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix argument N,
1324 expose all children down to level N@.
1325 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1326 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1327 buffer
1328 @ifinfo
1329 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1330 @end ifinfo
1331 @ifnotinfo
1332 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1333 @end ifnotinfo
1334 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1335 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1336 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1337 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1338 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1339 the previously used indirect buffer.
1340 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1341 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1342 @end table
1343
1344 @vindex org-startup-folded
1345 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1346 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1347 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1348 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1349
1350 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1351 OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1352 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1353 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1354 buffer:
1355
1356 @example
1357 #+STARTUP: overview
1358 #+STARTUP: content
1359 #+STARTUP: showall
1360 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1361 @end example
1362
1363 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1364 @noindent
1365 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1366 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1367 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1368 @code{all}.
1369 @table @asis
1370 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1371 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., whatever is
1372 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1373 entries.
1374 @end table
1375
1376 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1377 @section Motion
1378 @cindex motion, between headlines
1379 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1380 @cindex headline navigation
1381 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1382
1383 @table @asis
1384 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1385 Next heading.
1386 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1387 Previous heading.
1388 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1389 Next heading same level.
1390 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1391 Previous heading same level.
1392 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1393 Backward to higher level heading.
1394 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1395 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1396 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1397 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1398 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1399 @example
1400 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1401 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1402 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1403 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1404 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1405 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1406 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1407 u @r{One level up.}
1408 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1409 q @r{Quit}
1410 @end example
1411 @vindex org-goto-interface
1412 @noindent
1413 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1414 @end table
1415
1416 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1417 @section Structure editing
1418 @cindex structure editing
1419 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1420 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1421 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1422 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1423 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1424 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1425 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1426 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1427 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1428
1429 @table @asis
1430 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1431 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1432 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1433 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1434 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1435 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1436 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1437 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1438 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1439 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1440 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.,
1441 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1442 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1443 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1444 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1445 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1446 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1447 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1448 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1449 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1450 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1451 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1452 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1453 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1454 subtree.
1455 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1456 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1457 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1458 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1459 to the initial level.
1460 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1461 Promote current heading by one level.
1462 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1463 Demote current heading by one level.
1464 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1465 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1466 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1467 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1468 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1469 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1470 level).
1471 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1472 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1473 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1474 Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1475 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1476 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1477 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1478 sequential subtrees.
1479 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1480 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1481 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1482 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1483 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1484 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1485 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1486 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1487 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1488 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1489 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1490 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1491 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1492 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1493 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1494 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1495 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1496 folding.
1497 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1498 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1499 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1500 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1501 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1502 more details, see the docstring of the command
1503 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1504 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1505 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1506 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort}
1507 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1508 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1509 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1510 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1511 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1512 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1513 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1514 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1515 sorting will be case-sensitive.
1516 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1517 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1518 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1519 Narrow buffer to current block.
1520 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1521 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1522 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1523 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1524 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1525 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1526 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1527 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1528 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1529 @end table
1530
1531 @cindex region, active
1532 @cindex active region
1533 @cindex transient mark mode
1534 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1535 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1536 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1537 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1538 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1539 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1540 functionality.
1541
1542
1543 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1544 @section Sparse trees
1545 @cindex sparse trees
1546 @cindex trees, sparse
1547 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1548 @cindex occur, command
1549
1550 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1551 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1552 @vindex org-show-siblings
1553 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1554 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1555 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1556 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1557 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1558 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1559 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1560 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1561 and you will see immediately how it works.
1562
1563 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1564 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1565
1566 @table @asis
1567 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1568 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1569 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1570 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1571 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1572 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1573 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1574 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1575 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1576 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1577 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1578 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1579 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1580 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1581 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1582 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1583 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1584 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1585 @end table
1586
1587
1588 @noindent
1589 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1590 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1591 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1592 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1593 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1594 For example:
1595
1596 @lisp
1597 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1598 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1599 @end lisp
1600
1601 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1602 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1603
1604 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1605 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1606
1607 @kindex C-c C-e v
1608 @cindex printing sparse trees
1609 @cindex visible text, printing
1610 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1611 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1612 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1613 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1614 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1615 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1616
1617 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1618 @section Plain lists
1619 @cindex plain lists
1620 @cindex lists, plain
1621 @cindex lists, ordered
1622 @cindex ordered lists
1623
1624 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1625 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1626 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1627 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1628
1629 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1630 @itemize @bullet
1631 @item
1632 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1633 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1634 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1635 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1636 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1637 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1638 bullets.
1639 @item
1640 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1641 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1642 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1643 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1644 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1645 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1646 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1647 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1648 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1649 list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the text of the item
1650 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1651 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1652 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1653 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1654 @item
1655 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1656 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1657 description.
1658 @end itemize
1659
1660 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1661 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1662 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1663 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1664 than its bullet/number.
1665
1666 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1667 A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less
1668 or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1669 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1670 that case, all items are closed. Here is an example:
1671
1672 @example
1673 @group
1674 ** Lord of the Rings
1675 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1676 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1677 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1678 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1679 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1680 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1681 - on DVD only
1682 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1683 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1684 Important actors in this film are:
1685 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1686 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1687 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1688 @end group
1689 @end example
1690
1691 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1692 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1693 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1694 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1695 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1696 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1697 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1698
1699 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1700 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1701 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1702 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1703 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1704 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1705 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1706
1707 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1708 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1709 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1710 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1711 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1712 to disable them individually.
1713
1714 @table @asis
1715 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1716 @cindex cycling, in plain lists
1717 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1718 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1719 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1720 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1721 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1722 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the indentation of the
1723 bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real headlines, however; the
1724 hierarchies remain completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the
1725 first @key{TAB} demotes the item to become a child of the previous
1726 one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to meaningful levels in the list
1727 and eventually get it back to its initial position.
1728 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1729 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1730 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1731 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1732 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1733 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1734 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1735 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1736 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1737 one.
1738 @end table
1739
1740 @table @kbd
1741 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1742 @item M-S-RET
1743 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1744 @kindex S-@key{down}
1745 @item S-up
1746 @itemx S-down
1747 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1748 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1749 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1750 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1751 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1752 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1753 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1754 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1755 similar effect.
1756 @kindex M-@key{up}
1757 @kindex M-@key{down}
1758 @item M-up
1759 @itemx M-down
1760 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1761 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1762 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1763 is automatic.
1764 @kindex M-@key{left}
1765 @kindex M-@key{right}
1766 @item M-left
1767 @itemx M-right
1768 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1769 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1770 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1771 @item M-S-left
1772 @itemx M-S-right
1773 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1774 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1775 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1776 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1777 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1778 motion or so.
1779
1780 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1781 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1782 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1783 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1784 @kindex C-c C-c
1785 @item C-c C-c
1786 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1787 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1788 consistency in the whole list.
1789 @kindex C-c -
1790 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1791 @item C-c -
1792 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1793 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1794 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1795 and its indentation. With a numeric prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet
1796 from this list. If there is an active region when calling this, selected
1797 text will be changed into an item. With a prefix argument, all lines will be
1798 converted to list items. If the first line already was a list item, any item
1799 marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without an active
1800 region, a normal line will be converted into a list item.
1801 @kindex C-c *
1802 @item C-c *
1803 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1804 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1805 @kindex C-c C-*
1806 @item C-c C-*
1807 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1808 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1809 (resp. checked).
1810 @kindex S-@key{left}
1811 @kindex S-@key{right}
1812 @item S-left/right
1813 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1814 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1815 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1816 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1817 @kindex C-c ^
1818 @item C-c ^
1819 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1820 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1821 @end table
1822
1823 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1824 @section Drawers
1825 @cindex drawers
1826 @cindex #+DRAWERS
1827 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1828
1829 @vindex org-drawers
1830 @cindex org-insert-drawer
1831 @kindex C-c C-x d
1832 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1833 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1834 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1835 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define additional drawers on a
1836 per-file basis with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN STATE}}. Drawers
1837 look like this:
1838
1839 @example
1840 ** This is a headline
1841 Still outside the drawer
1842 :DRAWERNAME:
1843 This is inside the drawer.
1844 :END:
1845 After the drawer.
1846 @end example
1847
1848 You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling
1849 @code{org-insert-drawer}, which is bound to @key{C-c C-x d}. With an active
1850 region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a prefix
1851 argument, this command calls @code{org-insert-property-drawer} and add a
1852 property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over drawer
1853 keywords is also possible using @key{M-TAB}.
1854
1855 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1856 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1857 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1858 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1859 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1860 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1861 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1862 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1863
1864 @table @kbd
1865 @kindex C-c C-z
1866 @item C-c C-z
1867 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1868 @end table
1869
1870 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1871 @section Blocks
1872
1873 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1874 @cindex blocks, folding
1875 Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1876 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1877 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1878 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1879 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1880 or on a per-file basis by using
1881
1882 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1883 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1884 @example
1885 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1886 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1887 @end example
1888
1889 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1890 @section Footnotes
1891 @cindex footnotes
1892
1893 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1894 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1895 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1896 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e., a footnote is
1897 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1898 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1899 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1900 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1901
1902 @example
1903 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1904 ...
1905 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1906 @end example
1907
1908 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1909 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1910 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1911 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1912 @LaTeX{}}). Here are the valid references:
1913
1914 @table @code
1915 @item [1]
1916 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1917 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1918 snippet.
1919 @item [fn:name]
1920 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1921 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1922 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1923 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1924 reference point.
1925 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1926 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1927 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1928 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1929 @end table
1930
1931 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1932 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1933 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1934 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1935 for details.
1936
1937 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1938
1939 @table @kbd
1940 @kindex C-c C-x f
1941 @item C-c C-x f
1942 The footnote action command.
1943
1944 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1945 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1946
1947 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1948 @vindex org-footnote-section
1949 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1950 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1951 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1952 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1953 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1954 separately into the location determined by the variable
1955 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1956
1957 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1958 options is offered:
1959 @example
1960 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1961 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1962 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1963 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1964 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1965 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1966 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1967 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1968 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1969 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1970 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1971 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1972 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1973 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g., sending}
1974 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1975 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1976 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1977 @r{to it.}
1978 @end example
1979 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1980 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1981 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1982 deletion.
1983
1984 @kindex C-c C-c
1985 @item C-c C-c
1986 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1987 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1988 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1989 @kindex C-c C-o
1990 @kindex mouse-1
1991 @kindex mouse-2
1992 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1993 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1994 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1995 @end table
1996
1997 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1998 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1999 @cindex Orgstruct mode
2000 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
2001
2002 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
2003 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
2004 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
2005 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
2006 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
2007
2008 @lisp
2009 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
2010 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
2011 @end lisp
2012
2013 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
2014 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
2015 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
2016 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
2017 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
2018 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
2019 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
2020 item.
2021
2022 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
2023 @chapter Tables
2024 @cindex tables
2025 @cindex editing tables
2026
2027 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
2028 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
2029 (@pxref{Top, Calc, , calc, Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
2030
2031 @menu
2032 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
2033 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
2034 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
2035 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
2036 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
2037 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
2038 @end menu
2039
2040 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
2041 @section The built-in table editor
2042 @cindex table editor, built-in
2043
2044 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII@. Any line with @samp{|} as
2045 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
2046 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
2047 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
2048 might look like this:
2049
2050 @example
2051 | Name | Phone | Age |
2052 |-------+-------+-----|
2053 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
2054 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
2055 @end example
2056
2057 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
2058 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
2059 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
2060 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
2061 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
2062 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
2063 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
2064 create the above table, you would only type
2065
2066 @example
2067 |Name|Phone|Age|
2068 |-
2069 @end example
2070
2071 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
2072 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
2073 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
2074
2075 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
2076 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
2077 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
2078 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
2079 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
2080 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
2081 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
2082 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
2083 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
2084 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
2085
2086 @table @kbd
2087 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
2088 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2089 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
2090 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
2091 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
2092 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
2093 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
2094 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
2095 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
2096 @*
2097 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
2098 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
2099 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
2100
2101 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
2102 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
2103 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
2104 @c
2105 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
2106 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
2107 necessary.
2108 @c
2109 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
2110 Re-align, move to previous field.
2111 @c
2112 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
2113 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
2114 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
2115 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
2116 @c
2117 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2118 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2119 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2120 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2121
2122 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2123 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2124 Move the current column left/right.
2125 @c
2126 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2127 Kill the current column.
2128 @c
2129 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2130 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2131 @c
2132 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2133 Move the current row up/down.
2134 @c
2135 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2136 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2137 @c
2138 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2139 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2140 created below the current one.
2141 @c
2142 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2143 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2144 is created above the current line.
2145 @c
2146 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2147 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2148 below that line.
2149 @c
2150 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2151 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2152 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2153 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2154 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2155 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2156 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2157 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2158 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2159 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2160
2161 @tsubheading{Regions}
2162 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2163 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2164 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2165 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2166 @c
2167 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2168 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2169 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2170 @c
2171 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2172 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2173 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2174 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2175 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2176 lines.
2177 @c
2178 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2179 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2180 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2181 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2182 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2183 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2184 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2185 above.
2186
2187 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2188 @cindex formula, in tables
2189 @cindex calculations, in tables
2190 @cindex region, active
2191 @cindex active region
2192 @cindex transient mark mode
2193 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2194 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2195 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2196 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2197 @c
2198 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2199 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2200 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2201 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2202 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2203 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2204 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2205 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2206 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2207
2208 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2209 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2210 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2211 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2212 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2213 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2214 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2215 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2216 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2217 @c
2218 @item M-x org-table-import
2219 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2220 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2221 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2222 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2223 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2224 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2225 separator.
2226 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2227 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2228 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2229 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2230 @c
2231 @item M-x org-table-export
2232 @findex org-table-export
2233 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2234 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2235 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2236 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2237 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2238 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2239 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2240 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2241 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2242 detailed description.
2243 @end table
2244
2245 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2246 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2247 it off with
2248
2249 @lisp
2250 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2251 @end lisp
2252
2253 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2254 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2255
2256 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2257 @section Column width and alignment
2258 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2259 @cindex alignment in tables
2260
2261 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2262 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2263 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2264
2265 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2266 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2267 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2268 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2269 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2270 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2271 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2272
2273 @example
2274 @group
2275 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2276 | | | | | <6> |
2277 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2278 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2279 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2280 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2281 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2282 @end group
2283 @end example
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2287 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2288 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2289 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2290 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2291 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2292 C-c}.
2293
2294 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2295 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2296 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2297 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2298 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2299 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2300 on a per-file basis with:
2301
2302 @example
2303 #+STARTUP: align
2304 #+STARTUP: noalign
2305 @end example
2306
2307 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2308 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2309 @samp{<c>}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2310 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2311 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2312
2313 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2314 automatically when exporting the document.
2315
2316 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2317 @section Column groups
2318 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2319
2320 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2321 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2322 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2323 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2324 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2325 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2326 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2327 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} (no space between @samp{<}
2328 and @samp{>}) to make a column
2329 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2330 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2331
2332 @example
2333 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2334 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2335 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2336 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2337 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2338 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2339 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2340 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2341 @end example
2342
2343 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2344 every vertical line you would like to have:
2345
2346 @example
2347 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2348 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2349 | / | < | | | < | |
2350 @end example
2351
2352 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2353 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2354 @cindex Orgtbl mode
2355 @cindex minor mode for tables
2356
2357 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2358 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2359 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2360 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2361 example in Message mode, use
2362
2363 @lisp
2364 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2365 @end lisp
2366
2367 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2368 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2369 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2370 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2371 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2372
2373 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2374 @section The spreadsheet
2375 @cindex calculations, in tables
2376 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2377 @cindex @file{calc} package
2378
2379 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2380 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2381 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2382 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2383 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2384 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2385 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2386 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2387 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2388
2389 @menu
2390 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2391 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2392 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2393 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2394 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2395 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2396 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2397 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2398 * Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc
2399 @end menu
2400
2401 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2402 @subsection References
2403 @cindex references
2404
2405 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2406 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2407 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2408 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2409 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2410
2411 @subsubheading Field references
2412 @cindex field references
2413 @cindex references, to fields
2414
2415 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2416 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2417 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2418 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2419 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2420 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2421 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2422 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2423 representation that looks like this:
2424 @example
2425 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2426 @end example
2427
2428 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2429 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e., the
2430 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2431 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2432 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2433 column from the right.
2434
2435 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2436 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2437 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2438 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2439 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2440 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2441 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2442 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2443 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2444 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2445 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2446 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2447 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2448 after the third hline in the table.
2449
2450 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2451 i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2452 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2453 implied.
2454
2455 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2456 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2457 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2458 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2459 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2460 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2461
2462 Here are a few examples:
2463
2464 @example
2465 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2466 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2467 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2468 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2469 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2470 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2471 @end example
2472
2473 @subsubheading Range references
2474 @cindex range references
2475 @cindex references, to ranges
2476
2477 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2478 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2479 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2480 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2481 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2482 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2483
2484 @example
2485 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2486 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2487 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2488 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2489 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2490 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2491 @end example
2492
2493 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2494 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2495 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2496 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2497 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2498
2499 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2500 @cindex field coordinates
2501 @cindex coordinates, of field
2502 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2503 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2504
2505 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2506 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2507 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2508 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2509
2510 @example
2511 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2512 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2513 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2514 @end example
2515
2516 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2517 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2518 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2519 number of rows.
2520
2521 @subsubheading Named references
2522 @cindex named references
2523 @cindex references, named
2524 @cindex name, of column or field
2525 @cindex constants, in calculations
2526 @cindex #+CONSTANTS
2527
2528 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2529 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2530 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2531 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2532 line like
2533
2534 @example
2535 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2536 @end example
2537
2538 @noindent
2539 @vindex constants-unit-system
2540 @pindex constants.el
2541 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2542 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2543 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2544 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2545 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2546 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2547 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2548 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2549 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2550 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2551 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2552 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2553 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2554 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2555 numbers.
2556
2557 @subsubheading Remote references
2558 @cindex remote references
2559 @cindex references, remote
2560 @cindex references, to a different table
2561 @cindex name, of column or field
2562 @cindex constants, in calculations
2563 @cindex #+TBLNAME
2564
2565 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2566 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2567
2568 @example
2569 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2570 @end example
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2574 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2575 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2576 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2577 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2578 referenced table.
2579
2580 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2581 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2582 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2583 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2584
2585 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2586 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2587 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2588 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2589 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2590 Your Programs, calc-eval, Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs, calc, GNU
2591 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2592 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2593 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2594 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2595 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2596
2597 @cindex format specifier
2598 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2599 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2600 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2601 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2602 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2603 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2604 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2605 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2606 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2607
2608 @example
2609 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2610 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2611 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2612 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2613 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2614 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2615 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2616 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2617 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2618 L @r{literal}
2619 @end example
2620
2621 @noindent
2622 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2623 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2624 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2625 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2626 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2627 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2628 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2629 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2630 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2631 A few examples:
2632
2633 @example
2634 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2635 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2636 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2637 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2638 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2639 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2640 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2641 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2642 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2643 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2644 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2645 @end example
2646
2647 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2648
2649 @example
2650 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2651 @end example
2652
2653 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2654 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2655
2656 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2657 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2658 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2659
2660 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be useful
2661 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is
2662 not enough.
2663
2664 If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening parenthesis,
2665 then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should return either a
2666 string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes
2667 and a printf format after a semicolon.
2668
2669 With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field
2670 references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be
2671 interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If
2672 you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers
2673 (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without
2674 quotes. If you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated
2675 literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted
2676 as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in
2677 double-quotes, like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated
2678 fields, so you can embed them in list or vector syntax.
2679
2680 Here are a few examples---note how the @samp{N} mode is used when we do
2681 computations in Lisp:
2682
2683 @example
2684 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2685 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2686 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2687 '(+ $1 $2);N
2688 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1--4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2689 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2690 @end example
2691
2692 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2693 @subsection Durations and time values
2694 @cindex Duration, computing
2695 @cindex Time, computing
2696 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2697
2698 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2699 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2700
2701 @example
2702 @group
2703 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2704 |---------+----------+----------|
2705 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2706 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2707 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2708 @end group
2709 @end example
2710
2711 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2712 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2713 as @code{HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2714 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2715 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2716 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2717 example above).
2718
2719 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2720 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2721
2722 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2723 @subsection Field and range formulas
2724 @cindex field formula
2725 @cindex range formula
2726 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2727 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2728
2729 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2730 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2731 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2732 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2733 current field will be replaced with the result.
2734
2735 @cindex #+TBLFM
2736 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2737 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2738 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2739 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2740 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2741 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2742 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2743 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2744 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2745 of course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2746 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2747
2748 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2749 command
2750
2751 @table @kbd
2752 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2753 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2754 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2755 it to the current field, and stores it.
2756 @end table
2757
2758 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2759 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2760 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2761 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2762 directly.
2763
2764 @table @code
2765 @item $2=
2766 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2767 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2768 @item @@3=
2769 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2770 the last row.
2771 @item @@1$2..@@4$3=
2772 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2773 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2774 @item $name=
2775 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2776 @end table
2777
2778 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2779 @subsection Column formulas
2780 @cindex column formula
2781 @cindex formula, for table column
2782
2783 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2784 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2785 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2786 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2787 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2788 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2789 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2790
2791 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2792 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2793 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2794 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2795 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2796 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2797 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2798 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2799 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2800 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2801
2802 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2803 following command:
2804
2805 @table @kbd
2806 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2807 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2808 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2809 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2810 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g., @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2811 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2812 @end table
2813
2814 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2815 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2816 @cindex formula editing
2817 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2818
2819 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2820 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2821 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2822 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2823 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2824 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2825 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2826 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2827
2828 @table @kbd
2829 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2830 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2831 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2832 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2833 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2834 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2835 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2836 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2837 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2838 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2839 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2840 @kindex C-c @}
2841 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2842 @item C-c @}
2843 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2844 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2845 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2846 @kindex C-c @{
2847 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2848 @item C-c @{
2849 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2850 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2851 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2852 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2853 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2854 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2855 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2856 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2857 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2858 @table @kbd
2859 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2860 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2861 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2862 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2863 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2864 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2865 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2866 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2867 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2868 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2869 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2870 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2871 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2872 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2873 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2874 @kindex S-@key{up}
2875 @kindex S-@key{down}
2876 @kindex S-@key{left}
2877 @kindex S-@key{right}
2878 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2879 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2880 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2881 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2882 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2883 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2884 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2885 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2886 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2887 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2888 down.
2889 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2890 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2891 @kindex C-c @}
2892 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2893 @item C-c @}
2894 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2895 @end table
2896 @end table
2897
2898 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2899 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2900 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2901 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2902 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2903
2904 @kindex C-c C-c
2905 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2906 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2907 recalculation commands in the table.
2908
2909 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2910 @cindex formula debugging
2911 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2912 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2913 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2914 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2915 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2916 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2917 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2918
2919 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2920 @subsection Updating the table
2921 @cindex recomputing table fields
2922 @cindex updating, table
2923
2924 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2925 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2926 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2927
2928 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2929 following commands:
2930
2931 @table @kbd
2932 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2933 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2934 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2935 @c
2936 @kindex C-u C-c *
2937 @item C-u C-c *
2938 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2939 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2940 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2941 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2942 @c
2943 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2944 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2945 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2946 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2947 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2948 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2949 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2950 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2951 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2952 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2953 dependencies.
2954 @end table
2955
2956 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2957 @subsection Advanced features
2958
2959 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if you
2960 want to be able to assign @i{names}@footnote{Such names must start by an
2961 alphabetic character and use only alphanumeric/underscore characters.} to
2962 fields and columns, you need to reserve the first column of the table for
2963 special marking characters.
2964
2965 @table @kbd
2966 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2967 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2968 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2969 change all marks in the region.
2970 @end table
2971
2972 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2973 makes use of these features:
2974
2975 @example
2976 @group
2977 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2978 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2979 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2980 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2981 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2982 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2983 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2984 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2985 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2986 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2987 | | Average | | | | 25.0 | |
2988 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2989 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2990 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2991 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2992 @end group
2993 @end example
2994
2995 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2996 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2997 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2998 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2999 empty first field.
3000
3001 @cindex marking characters, tables
3002 The marking characters have the following meaning:
3003 @table @samp
3004 @item !
3005 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
3006 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
3007 @item ^
3008 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
3009 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
3010 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
3011 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
3012 @item _
3013 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
3014 @emph{below}.
3015 @item $
3016 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
3017 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
3018 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
3019 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
3020 a per-table basis.
3021 @item #
3022 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
3023 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
3024 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
3025 lines will be left alone by this command.
3026 @item *
3027 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
3028 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
3029 recalculation slows down editing too much.
3030 @item
3031 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
3032 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
3033 or @samp{*}.
3034 @item /
3035 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
3036 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
3037 @end table
3038
3039 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
3040 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
3041 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
3042 functions.
3043
3044 @example
3045 @group
3046 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3047 | | Func | n | x | Result |
3048 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3049 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
3050 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
3051 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
3052 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
3053 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
3054 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
3055 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
3056 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
3057 @end group
3058 @end example
3059
3060 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
3061 @section Org-Plot
3062 @cindex graph, in tables
3063 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
3064 @cindex #+PLOT
3065
3066 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
3067 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
3068 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
3069 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
3070 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
3071
3072 @example
3073 @group
3074 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
3075 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
3076 |-----------+-----------+---------|
3077 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
3078 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
3079 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
3080 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
3081 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
3082 @end group
3083 @end example
3084
3085 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
3086 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
3087 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
3088 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
3089 see the Org-plot tutorial at
3090 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
3091
3092 @subsubheading Plot Options
3093
3094 @table @code
3095 @item set
3096 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
3097
3098 @item title
3099 Specify the title of the plot.
3100
3101 @item ind
3102 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
3103
3104 @item deps
3105 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
3106 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
3107 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
3108 column).
3109
3110 @item type
3111 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
3112
3113 @item with
3114 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
3115 (e.g., @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
3116 Defaults to @code{lines}.
3117
3118 @item file
3119 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
3120
3121 @item labels
3122 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3123 if they exist).
3124
3125 @item line
3126 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3127
3128 @item map
3129 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3130 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3131
3132 @item timefmt
3133 Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3134 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3135
3136 @item script
3137 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3138 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3139 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3140 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3141 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3142 the data file.
3143 @end table
3144
3145 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3146 @chapter Hyperlinks
3147 @cindex hyperlinks
3148
3149 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3150 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3151
3152 @menu
3153 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3154 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3155 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3156 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3157 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3158 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3159 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3160 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3161 @end menu
3162
3163 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3164 @section Link format
3165 @cindex link format
3166 @cindex format, of links
3167
3168 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3169 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3170
3171 @example
3172 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3173 @end example
3174
3175 @noindent
3176 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3177 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3178 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3179 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3180 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3181 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3182 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3183 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3184 cursor on the link.
3185
3186 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3187 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3188 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3189 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3190 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3191 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3192 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3193
3194 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3195 @section Internal links
3196 @cindex internal links
3197 @cindex links, internal
3198 @cindex targets, for links
3199
3200 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3201 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3202 current file. The most important case is a link like
3203 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3204 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3205 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3206 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3207 in a file.
3208
3209 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3210 lead to a text search in the current file.
3211
3212 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3213 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3214 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3215 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3216 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3217 comment line. For example
3218
3219 @example
3220 # <<My Target>>
3221 @end example
3222
3223 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3224 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3225 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3226 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3227 first headline.}.
3228
3229 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3230 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3231 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3232 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3233 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3234 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3235 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3236
3237 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3238 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3239 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3240 earlier.
3241
3242 @menu
3243 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3244 @end menu
3245
3246 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3247 @subsection Radio targets
3248 @cindex radio targets
3249 @cindex targets, radio
3250 @cindex links, radio targets
3251
3252 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3253 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3254 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3255 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3256 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3257 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3258 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3259 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3260 cursor on or at a target.
3261
3262 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3263 @section External links
3264 @cindex links, external
3265 @cindex external links
3266 @cindex links, external
3267 @cindex Gnus links
3268 @cindex BBDB links
3269 @cindex IRC links
3270 @cindex URL links
3271 @cindex file links
3272 @cindex VM links
3273 @cindex RMAIL links
3274 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3275 @cindex MH-E links
3276 @cindex USENET links
3277 @cindex SHELL links
3278 @cindex Info links
3279 @cindex Elisp links
3280
3281 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3282 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3283 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3284 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3285 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3286
3287 @example
3288 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3289 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3290 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3291 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3292 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3293 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3294 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3295 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3296 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file, jump to line number}
3297 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3298 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}@footnote{
3299 The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of
3300 the variable @code{org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline}. If its value
3301 is nil, then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is t, then only the
3302 exact headline will be matched. If the value is @code{'query-to-create},
3303 then an exact headline will be searched; if it is not found, then the user
3304 will be queried to create it.}
3305 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3306 file+sys:/path/to/file @r{open via OS, like double-click}
3307 file+emacs:/path/to/file @r{force opening by Emacs}
3308 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open in doc-view mode at page}
3309 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3310 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3311 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3312 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3313 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3314 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3315 vm-imap:account:folder @r{VM IMAP folder link}
3316 vm-imap:account:folder#id @r{VM IMAP message link}
3317 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3318 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3319 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3320 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3321 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3322 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3323 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3324 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3325 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3326 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3327 info:org#External links @r{Info node link}
3328 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3329 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3330 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3331 @end example
3332
3333 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3334
3335 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3336 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3337 format}), for example:
3338
3339 @example
3340 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3341 @end example
3342
3343 @noindent
3344 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3345 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3346 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3347 image,
3348 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3349
3350 @cindex square brackets, around links
3351 @cindex plain text external links
3352 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3353 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3354 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3355 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3356
3357 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3358 @section Handling links
3359 @cindex links, handling
3360
3361 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3362 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3363
3364 @table @kbd
3365 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3366 @cindex storing links
3367 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3368 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3369 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3370 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3371 buffer:
3372
3373 @b{Org mode buffers}@*
3374 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3375 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3376 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3377 removed from the link and result in a wrong link---you should avoid putting
3378 timestamp in the headline.}.
3379
3380 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3381 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3382 @cindex property, ID
3383 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3384 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3385 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3386 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3387 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3388 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3389 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3390 to use.
3391
3392 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3393 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3394 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3395 constructed from the author and the subject.
3396
3397 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3398 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3399
3400 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3401 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3402
3403 @b{Chat: IRC}@*
3404 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3405 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3406 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3407 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3408 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3409
3410 @b{Other files}@*
3411 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3412 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3413 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3414 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3415 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3416 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3417 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3418
3419 @b{Agenda view}@*
3420 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3421 entry referenced by the current line.
3422
3423 @c
3424 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3425 @cindex link completion
3426 @cindex completion, of links
3427 @cindex inserting links
3428 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3429 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3430 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3431 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3432 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3433 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3434 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3435 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3436 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3437 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3438 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3439 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3440 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3441 becomes the default description.
3442
3443 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3444 All links stored during the
3445 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3446 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3447
3448 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3449 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3450 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3451 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3452 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3453 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3454 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3455 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3456 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3457 @orgkey C-u C-c C-l
3458 @cindex file name completion
3459 @cindex completion, of file names
3460 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3461 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3462 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3463 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3464 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3465 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3466 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3467 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3468 @c
3469 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3470 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3471 link and description parts of the link.
3472 @c
3473 @cindex following links
3474 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3475 @vindex org-file-apps
3476 @vindex org-link-frame-setup
3477 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3478 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3479 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3480 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3481 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3482 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3483 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3484 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3485 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3486 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3487 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3488 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3489 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3490 headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame configuration for
3491 following links, customize @code{org-link-frame-setup}.
3492
3493 @orgkey @key{RET}
3494 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3495 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3496 the link at point.
3497 @c
3498 @kindex mouse-2
3499 @kindex mouse-1
3500 @item mouse-2
3501 @itemx mouse-1
3502 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3503 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3504 @c
3505 @kindex mouse-3
3506 @item mouse-3
3507 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3508 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3509 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3510 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3511 @c
3512 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3513 @cindex inlining images
3514 @cindex images, inlining
3515 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3516 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3517 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3518 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3519 images that have no description part in the link, i.e., images that will also
3520 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3521 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3522 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3523 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3524 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3525 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3526 @cindex mark ring
3527 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3528 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3529 @c
3530 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3531 @cindex links, returning to
3532 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3533 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3534 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3535 previously recorded positions.
3536 @c
3537 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3538 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3539 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3540 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3541 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3542 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3543 @lisp
3544 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3545 (lambda ()
3546 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3547 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3548 @end lisp
3549 @end table
3550
3551 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3552 @section Using links outside Org
3553
3554 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3555 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3556 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3557 yourself):
3558
3559 @lisp
3560 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3561 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3562 @end lisp
3563
3564 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3565 @section Link abbreviations
3566 @cindex link abbreviations
3567 @cindex abbreviation, links
3568
3569 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3570 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3571 abbreviated link looks like this
3572
3573 @example
3574 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3575 @end example
3576
3577 @noindent
3578 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3579 where the tag is optional.
3580 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3581 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3582 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3583 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3584
3585 @smalllisp
3586 @group
3587 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3588 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3589 ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h")
3590 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3591 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3592 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3593 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3594 @end group
3595 @end smalllisp
3596
3597 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3598 replaced with the tag. Using @samp{%h} instead of @samp{%s} will
3599 url-encode the tag (see the example above, where we need to encode
3600 the URL parameter.) Using @samp{%(my-function)} will pass the tag
3601 to a custom function, and replace it by the resulting string.
3602
3603 If the replacement text don't contain any specifier, it will simply
3604 be appended to the string in order to create the link.
3605
3606 Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be
3607 called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3608
3609 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3610 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3611 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3612 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3613 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3614 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3615 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3616
3617 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3618 can define them in the file with
3619
3620 @cindex #+LINK
3621 @example
3622 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3623 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3624 @end example
3625
3626 @noindent
3627 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3628 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3629 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
3630 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3631 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3632
3633 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3634 @section Search options in file links
3635 @cindex search option in file links
3636 @cindex file links, searching
3637
3638 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3639 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3640 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3641 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3642 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3643 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3644 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3645 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3646
3647 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3648 link, together with an explanation:
3649
3650 @example
3651 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3652 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3653 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3654 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3655 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3656 @end example
3657
3658 @table @code
3659 @item 255
3660 Jump to line 255.
3661 @item My Target
3662 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3663 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3664 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3665 link will become a HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3666 the linked file.
3667 @item *My Target
3668 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3669 @item #my-custom-id
3670 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3671 @item /regexp/
3672 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3673 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3674 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3675 sparse tree with the matches.
3676 @c If the target file is a directory,
3677 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3678 @end table
3679
3680 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3681 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3682 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3683 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3684
3685 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3686 @section Custom Searches
3687 @cindex custom search strings
3688 @cindex search strings, custom
3689
3690 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3691 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3692 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3693 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3694 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3695 citation key.
3696
3697 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3698 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3699 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3700 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3701 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3702 to be added to the hook variables
3703 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3704 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3705 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3706 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3707 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3708
3709 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3710 @chapter TODO items
3711 @cindex TODO items
3712
3713 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3714 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3715 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3716 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3717 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3718 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3719 item emerged is always present.
3720
3721 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3722 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3723 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3724
3725 @menu
3726 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3727 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3728 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3729 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3730 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3731 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3732 @end menu
3733
3734 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3735 @section Basic TODO functionality
3736
3737 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3738 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3739
3740 @example
3741 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3742 @end example
3743
3744 @noindent
3745 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3746
3747 @table @kbd
3748 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3749 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3750 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3751
3752 @example
3753 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3754 '--------------------------------'
3755 @end example
3756
3757 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3758 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3759
3760 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3761 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3762 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3763 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3764 more information.
3765
3766 @kindex S-@key{right}
3767 @kindex S-@key{left}
3768 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3769 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3770 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3771 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3772 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3773 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3774 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3775 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-tree}
3776 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3777 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3778 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3779 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3780 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3781 / T}), search for a specific TODO@. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3782 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3783 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3784 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3785 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3786 both un-done and done.
3787 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3788 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3789 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3790 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3791 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3792 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3793 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3794 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3795 @end table
3796
3797 @noindent
3798 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3799 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3800 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3801
3802 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3803 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3804 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3805
3806 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3807 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3808 DONE@. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3809 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3810 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3811 files.
3812
3813 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3814 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3815
3816 @menu
3817 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3818 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3819 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3820 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3821 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3822 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3823 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3824 @end menu
3825
3826 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3827 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3828 @cindex TODO workflow
3829 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3830
3831 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3832 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3833 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3834 buffer.}:
3835
3836 @lisp
3837 (setq org-todo-keywords
3838 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3839 @end lisp
3840
3841 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3842 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3843 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3844 state.
3845 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3846 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3847 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED@. You may
3848 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3849 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY@.
3850 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3851 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3852 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3853 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3854 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3855 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3856
3857 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3858 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3859 @cindex TODO types
3860 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3861 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3862
3863 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3864 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3865 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3866 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3867 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3868 be set up like this:
3869
3870 @lisp
3871 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3872 @end lisp
3873
3874 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3875 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3876 person, and later to mark it DONE@. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3877 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3878 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3879 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3880 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3881 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3882 to DONE@. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3883 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3884 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3885 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3886 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3887 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3888
3889 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3890 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3891 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3892
3893 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3894 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3895 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3896 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3897 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3898 like this:
3899
3900 @lisp
3901 (setq org-todo-keywords
3902 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3903 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3904 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3905 @end lisp
3906
3907 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3908 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3909 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3910 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3911 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3912 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3913 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3914
3915 @table @kbd
3916 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3917 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3918 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3919 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3920 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3921 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3922 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3923 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3924 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3925 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3926 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3927 @kindex S-@key{right}
3928 @kindex S-@key{left}
3929 @item S-@key{right}
3930 @itemx S-@key{left}
3931 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3932 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3933 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3934 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3935 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3936 @end table
3937
3938 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3939 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3940
3941 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3942 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for single-letter
3943 access to the states. This is done by adding the selection character after
3944 each keyword, in parentheses@footnote{All characters are allowed except
3945 @code{@@^!}, which have a special meaning here.}. For example:
3946
3947 @lisp
3948 (setq org-todo-keywords
3949 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3950 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3951 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3952 @end lisp
3953
3954 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3955 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3956 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3957 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3958 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3959 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3960 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3961 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3962
3963 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3964 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3965 @cindex keyword options
3966 @cindex per-file keywords
3967 @cindex #+TODO
3968 @cindex #+TYP_TODO
3969 @cindex #+SEQ_TODO
3970
3971 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3972 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3973 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3974 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3975 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3976 file:
3977
3978 @example
3979 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3980 @end example
3981 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3982 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3983 @example
3984 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3985 @end example
3986
3987 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3988
3989 @example
3990 #+TODO: TODO | DONE
3991 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3992 #+TODO: | CANCELED
3993 @end example
3994
3995 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3996 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3997 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3998 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3999
4000 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
4001 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
4002 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
4003 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
4004 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
4005 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
4006 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
4007 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
4008 for the current buffer.}.
4009
4010 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
4011 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
4012 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
4013
4014 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
4015 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
4016 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
4017 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
4018 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
4019 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
4020 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
4021 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
4022 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
4023
4024 @lisp
4025 @group
4026 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
4027 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
4028 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
4029 @end group
4030 @end lisp
4031
4032 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
4033 work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
4034 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
4035 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
4036 foreground or a background color.
4037
4038 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
4039 @subsection TODO dependencies
4040 @cindex TODO dependencies
4041 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
4042
4043 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4044 @cindex property, ORDERED
4045 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
4046 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
4047 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE@. And sometimes
4048 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
4049 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
4050 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
4051 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE@.
4052 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
4053 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE@. Here is an
4054 example:
4055
4056 @example
4057 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
4058 ** DONE one
4059 ** TODO two
4060
4061 * Parent
4062 :PROPERTIES:
4063 :ORDERED: t
4064 :END:
4065 ** TODO a
4066 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
4067 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
4068 @end example
4069
4070 @table @kbd
4071 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4072 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4073 @cindex property, ORDERED
4074 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
4075 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
4076 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
4077 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
4078 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4079 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
4080 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
4084 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
4085 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
4086 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
4087
4088 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
4089 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
4090 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
4091 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
4092 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
4093 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
4094
4095 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
4096 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
4097 module @file{org-depend.el}.
4098
4099 @page
4100 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
4101 @section Progress logging
4102 @cindex progress logging
4103 @cindex logging, of progress
4104
4105 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
4106 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
4107 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
4108 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
4109 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
4110 work time}.
4111
4112 @menu
4113 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
4114 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
4115 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
4116 @end menu
4117
4118 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
4119 @subsection Closing items
4120
4121 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
4122 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
4123 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
4124
4125 @lisp
4126 (setq org-log-done 'time)
4127 @end lisp
4128
4129 @noindent
4130 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
4131 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
4132 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
4133 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
4134 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
4135 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
4136
4137 @lisp
4138 (setq org-log-done 'note)
4139 @end lisp
4140
4141 @noindent
4142 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
4143 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
4144
4145 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
4146 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4147 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4148 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4149
4150 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4151 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4152 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4153
4154 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4155 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4156 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4157 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4158 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4159 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4160 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4161 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4162 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4163 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4164 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this behavior---the
4165 recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}@footnote{Note that the
4166 @code{LOGBOOK} drawer is unfolded when pressing @key{SPC} in the agenda to
4167 show an entry---use @key{C-u SPC} to keep it folded here}. You can also
4168 overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4169 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4170
4171 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
4172 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4173 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) or @samp{@@} (for a note
4174 with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the
4175 setting
4176
4177 @lisp
4178 (setq org-todo-keywords
4179 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4180 @end lisp
4181
4182 To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured with
4183 @samp{@@}, just type @kbd{C-c C-c} to enter a blank note when prompted.
4184
4185 @noindent
4186 @vindex org-log-done
4187 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4188 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4189 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
4190 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4191 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4192 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4193 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4194 WAIT or CANCELED@. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4195 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4196 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4197 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4198 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4199 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4200 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4201 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4202 configured.
4203
4204 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4205 to a buffer:
4206 @example
4207 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4208 @end example
4209
4210 @cindex property, LOGGING
4211 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4212 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4213 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4214 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4215 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4216 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4217
4218 @example
4219 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4220 :PROPERTIES:
4221 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4222 :END:
4223 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4224 :PROPERTIES:
4225 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4226 :END:
4227 * TODO No logging at all
4228 :PROPERTIES:
4229 :LOGGING: nil
4230 :END:
4231 @end example
4232
4233 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4234 @subsection Tracking your habits
4235 @cindex habits
4236
4237 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4238 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4239
4240 @enumerate
4241 @item
4242 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4243 @code{org-modules}.
4244 @item
4245 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4246 @item
4247 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4248 @item
4249 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4250 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4251 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4252 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4253 @item
4254 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4255 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4256 three days, but at most every two days.
4257 @item
4258 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled
4259 (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}), in order for historical data to be
4260 represented in the consistency graph. If it is not enabled it is not an
4261 error, but the consistency graphs will be largely meaningless.
4262 @end enumerate
4263
4264 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4265 actual habit with some history:
4266
4267 @example
4268 ** TODO Shave
4269 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4270 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4271 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4272 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4273 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4274 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4275 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4276 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4277 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4278 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4279 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4280 :PROPERTIES:
4281 :STYLE: habit
4282 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4283 :END:
4284 @end example
4285
4286 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4287 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4288 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4289 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4290 after four days have elapsed.
4291
4292 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4293 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4294 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4295 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4296
4297 @table @code
4298 @item Blue
4299 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4300 @item Green
4301 If the task could have been done on that day.
4302 @item Yellow
4303 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4304 @item Red
4305 If the task was overdue on that day.
4306 @end table
4307
4308 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4309 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4310 the current day falls in the graph.
4311
4312 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4313 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4314
4315 @table @code
4316 @item org-habit-graph-column
4317 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4318 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4319 titles brief and to the point.
4320 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4321 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4322 @item org-habit-following-days
4323 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4324 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4325 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4326 default.
4327 @end table
4328
4329 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4330 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4331 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4332 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4333
4334 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4335 @section Priorities
4336 @cindex priorities
4337
4338 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4339 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4340 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4341
4342 @example
4343 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4344 @end example
4345
4346 @noindent
4347 @vindex org-priority-faces
4348 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4349 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4350 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4351 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4352 have no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4353 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4354
4355 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4356 items.
4357
4358 @table @kbd
4359 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
4360 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
4361 @findex org-priority
4362 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4363 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4364 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4365 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4366 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4367 @c
4368 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4369 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4370 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4371 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4372 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4373 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4374 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4375 @end table
4376
4377 @vindex org-highest-priority
4378 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4379 @vindex org-default-priority
4380 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4381 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4382 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4383 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4384 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4385 priority):
4386
4387 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4388 @example
4389 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
4390 @end example
4391
4392 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4393 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4394 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4395 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4396
4397 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4398 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4399 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4400 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4401 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4402 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4403 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4404 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4405 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4406
4407 @example
4408 * Organize Party [33%]
4409 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4410 *** TODO Peter
4411 *** DONE Sarah
4412 ** TODO Buy food
4413 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4414 @end example
4415
4416 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4417 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4418 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4419 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4420 this issue.
4421
4422 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4423 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4424 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4425 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4426 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4427 property.
4428
4429 @example
4430 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4431 :PROPERTIES:
4432 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4433 :END:
4434 @end example
4435
4436 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4437 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4438
4439 @example
4440 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4441 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4442 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4443 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4444
4445 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4446 @end example
4447
4448
4449 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4450 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4451
4452
4453 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4454 @section Checkboxes
4455 @cindex checkboxes
4456
4457 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4458 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4459 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4460 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4461 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4462 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4463 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4464 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4465 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4466 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4467
4468 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4469
4470 @example
4471 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4472 - [-] call people [1/3]
4473 - [ ] Peter
4474 - [X] Sarah
4475 - [ ] Sam
4476 - [X] order food
4477 - [ ] think about what music to play
4478 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4479 @end example
4480
4481 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4482 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4483 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4484 checked.
4485
4486 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4487 @cindex checkbox statistics
4488 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4489 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4490 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4491 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4492 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4493 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4494 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4495 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4496 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4497 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4498 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4499 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4500 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4501 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4502 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4503 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4504 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4505 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4506 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4507
4508 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4509 @cindex checkbox blocking
4510 @cindex property, ORDERED
4511 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4512 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4513 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4514
4515 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4516
4517 @table @kbd
4518 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4519 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
4520 With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or remove the current
4521 one@footnote{`C-u C-c C-c' on the @emph{first} item of a list with no checkbox
4522 will add checkboxes to the rest of the list.}. With a double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is
4523 considered to be an intermediate state.
4524 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4525 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4526 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4527 intermediate state.
4528 @itemize @minus
4529 @item
4530 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4531 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4532 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4533 @item
4534 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4535 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4536 @item
4537 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4538 @end itemize
4539 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4540 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4541 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4542 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4543 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4544 @cindex property, ORDERED
4545 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4546 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4547 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4548 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4549 for better visibility, customize the variable
4550 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4551 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4552 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4553 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4554 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4555 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4556 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4557 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4558 @end table
4559
4560 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4561 @chapter Tags
4562 @cindex tags
4563 @cindex headline tagging
4564 @cindex matching, tags
4565 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4566
4567 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4568 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
4569 support for tags.
4570
4571 @vindex org-tag-faces
4572 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4573 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4574 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4575 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4576 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4577 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4578 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4579 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4580
4581 @menu
4582 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4583 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4584 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4585 @end menu
4586
4587 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4588 @section Tag inheritance
4589 @cindex tag inheritance
4590 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4591 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4592
4593 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4594 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4595 well. For example, in the list
4596
4597 @example
4598 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4599 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4600 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4601 @end example
4602
4603 @noindent
4604 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4605 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4606 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4607 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4608 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4609 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4610 changes in the line.}:
4611
4612 @cindex #+FILETAGS
4613 @example
4614 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4615 @end example
4616
4617 @noindent
4618 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4619 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4620 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4621 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4622 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4623
4624 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4625 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4626 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4627 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4628 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4629 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4630 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4631 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4632
4633 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4634 @section Setting tags
4635 @cindex setting tags
4636 @cindex tags, setting
4637
4638 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4639 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4640 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4641 also a special command for inserting tags:
4642
4643 @table @kbd
4644 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4645 @cindex completion, of tags
4646 @vindex org-tags-column
4647 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4648 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4649 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4650 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4651 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4652 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4653 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4654 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4655 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4656 @end table
4657
4658 @vindex org-tag-alist
4659 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4660 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4661 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4662 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4663 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4664
4665 @cindex #+TAGS
4666 @example
4667 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4668 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4669 @end example
4670
4671 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4672 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4673 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4674
4675 @example
4676 #+TAGS:
4677 @end example
4678
4679 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4680 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4681 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4682 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4683 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4684 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4685
4686 @example
4687 #+STARTUP: noptag
4688 @end example
4689
4690 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4691 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4692 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4693 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4694 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4695 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4696 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4697 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4698 like:
4699
4700 @lisp
4701 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4702 @end lisp
4703
4704 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4705 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4706
4707 @example
4708 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4709 @end example
4710
4711 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4712 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4713 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4714
4715 @example
4716 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4717 @end example
4718
4719 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4720
4721 @example
4722 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4723 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4724 @end example
4725
4726 @noindent
4727 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4728 braces, as in:
4729
4730 @example
4731 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4732 @end example
4733
4734 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4735 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4736
4737 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4738 these lines to activate any changes.
4739
4740 @noindent
4741 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4742 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4743 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4744 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4745 configuration:
4746
4747 @lisp
4748 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4749 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4750 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4751 (:endgroup . nil)
4752 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4753 @end lisp
4754
4755 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4756 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4757 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4758 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4759 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4760 keys:
4761
4762 @table @kbd
4763 @item a-z...
4764 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4765 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4766 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4767 @kindex @key{TAB}
4768 @item @key{TAB}
4769 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4770 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4771 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4772
4773 @kindex @key{SPC}
4774 @item @key{SPC}
4775 Clear all tags for this line.
4776 @kindex @key{RET}
4777 @item @key{RET}
4778 Accept the modified set.
4779 @item C-g
4780 Abort without installing changes.
4781 @item q
4782 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4783 @item !
4784 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4785 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4786 @item C-c
4787 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4788 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4789 selection window.
4790 @end table
4791
4792 @noindent
4793 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4794 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4795 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4796 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4797 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4798 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4799 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4800 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4801
4802 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4803 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4804 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4805 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4806 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4807 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4808 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4809 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4810 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4811 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4812 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4813
4814 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4815 @section Tag searches
4816 @cindex tag searches
4817 @cindex searching for tags
4818
4819 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4820 information into special lists.
4821
4822 @table @kbd
4823 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4824 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4825 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4826 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4827 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4828 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4829 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4830 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4831 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4832 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4833 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4834 @end table
4835
4836 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4837 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4838 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4839 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4840 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4841 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4842 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4843
4844
4845 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4846 @chapter Properties and columns
4847 @cindex properties
4848
4849 A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties can be
4850 set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry in a tree,
4851 or with every entry in an Org mode file.
4852
4853 There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First,
4854 properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file where
4855 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4856 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, you can use a
4857 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4858 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. Second, you can use properties to
4859 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine
4860 keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such as the
4861 album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on.
4862
4863 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4864 (@pxref{Column view}).
4865
4866 @menu
4867 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4868 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4869 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4870 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4871 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4872 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4873 @end menu
4874
4875 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4876 @section Property syntax
4877 @cindex property syntax
4878 @cindex drawer, for properties
4879
4880 Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single entry
4881 or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special
4882 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4883 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4884 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4885
4886 @example
4887 * CD collection
4888 ** Classic
4889 *** Goldberg Variations
4890 :PROPERTIES:
4891 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4892 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4893 :Artist: Glen Gould
4894 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4895 :NDisks: 1
4896 :END:
4897 @end example
4898
4899 Depending on the value of @code{org-use-property-inheritance}, a property set
4900 this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the sub-tree
4901 defined by the entry, see @ref{Property inheritance}.
4902
4903 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4904 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4905 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4906 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4907 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4908 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4909 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4910
4911 @example
4912 * CD collection
4913 :PROPERTIES:
4914 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4915 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4916 :END:
4917 @end example
4918
4919 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4920 file, use a line like
4921 @cindex property, _ALL
4922 @cindex #+PROPERTY
4923 @example
4924 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4925 @end example
4926
4927 If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a @code{+} to
4928 the property name. The following results in the property @code{var} having
4929 the value ``foo=1 bar=2''.
4930 @cindex property, +
4931 @example
4932 #+PROPERTY: var foo=1
4933 #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2
4934 @end example
4935
4936 It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. The
4937 following results in the @code{genres} property having the value ``Classic
4938 Baroque'' under the @code{Goldberg Variations} subtree.
4939 @cindex property, +
4940 @example
4941 * CD collection
4942 ** Classic
4943 :PROPERTIES:
4944 :GENRES: Classic
4945 :END:
4946 *** Goldberg Variations
4947 :PROPERTIES:
4948 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4949 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4950 :Artist: Glen Gould
4951 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4952 :NDisks: 1
4953 :GENRES+: Baroque
4954 :END:
4955 @end example
4956 Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer.
4957
4958 @vindex org-global-properties
4959 Property values set with the global variable
4960 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4961 Org files.
4962
4963 @noindent
4964 The following commands help to work with properties:
4965
4966 @table @kbd
4967 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4968 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4969 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4970 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4971 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4972 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4973 @item C-u M-x org-insert-drawer
4974 @cindex org-insert-drawer
4975 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4976 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4977 information like deadlines.
4978 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4979 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4980 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4981 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4982 can be inserted using completion.
4983 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4984 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4985 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4986 Remove a property from the current entry.
4987 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4988 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4989 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4990 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4991 nearest column format definition.
4992 @end table
4993
4994 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4995 @section Special properties
4996 @cindex properties, special
4997
4998 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode features,
4999 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
5000 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
5001 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
5002 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
5003 used as keys in the properties drawer:
5004
5005 @cindex property, special, ID
5006 @cindex property, special, TODO
5007 @cindex property, special, TAGS
5008 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
5009 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
5010 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
5011 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
5012 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
5013 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
5014 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
5015 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
5016 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
5017 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
5018 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
5019 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
5020 @cindex property, special, ITEM
5021 @cindex property, special, FILE
5022 @example
5023 ID @r{A globally unique ID used for synchronization during}
5024 @r{iCalendar or MobileOrg export.}
5025 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
5026 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
5027 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
5028 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
5029 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
5030 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
5031 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
5032 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
5033 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
5034 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
5035 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
5036 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
5037 CLOCKSUM_T @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today.}
5038 @r{@code{org-clock-sum-today} must be run first to compute the}
5039 @r{values in the current buffer.}
5040 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
5041 ITEM @r{The headline of the entry.}
5042 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
5043 @end example
5044
5045 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
5046 @section Property searches
5047 @cindex properties, searching
5048 @cindex searching, of properties
5049
5050 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
5051 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5052 @table @kbd
5053 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
5054 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
5055 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
5056 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
5057 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
5058 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
5059 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
5060 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
5061 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
5062 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
5063 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
5064 @end table
5065
5066 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
5067 properties}.
5068
5069 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
5070 single property:
5071
5072 @table @kbd
5073 @orgkey{C-c / p}
5074 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
5075 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
5076 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
5077 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
5078 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
5079 @end table
5080
5081 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
5082 @section Property Inheritance
5083 @cindex properties, inheritance
5084 @cindex inheritance, of properties
5085
5086 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
5087 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an
5088 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
5089 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
5090 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
5091 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
5092 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
5093 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
5094 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
5095 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
5096 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
5097 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
5098 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
5099
5100 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
5101 least for the special applications for which they are used:
5102
5103 @cindex property, COLUMNS
5104 @table @code
5105 @item COLUMNS
5106 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
5107 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
5108 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
5109 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
5110 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
5111 @item CATEGORY
5112 @cindex property, CATEGORY
5113 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
5114 applies to the entire subtree.
5115 @item ARCHIVE
5116 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
5117 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
5118 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
5119 @item LOGGING
5120 @cindex property, LOGGING
5121 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
5122 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
5123 @end table
5124
5125 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
5126 @section Column view
5127
5128 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
5129 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
5130 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
5131 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
5132 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
5133 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
5134 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
5135 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
5136 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
5137 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
5138 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
5139 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
5140 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
5141
5142 @menu
5143 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
5144 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
5145 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
5146 @end menu
5147
5148 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
5149 @subsection Defining columns
5150 @cindex column view, for properties
5151 @cindex properties, column view
5152
5153 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
5154 done by defining a column format line.
5155
5156 @menu
5157 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
5158 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
5159 @end menu
5160
5161 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
5162 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
5163
5164 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
5165
5166 @cindex #+COLUMNS
5167 @example
5168 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5169 @end example
5170
5171 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
5172 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
5173
5174 @example
5175 ** Top node for columns view
5176 :PROPERTIES:
5177 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
5178 :END:
5179 @end example
5180
5181 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
5182 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
5183 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
5184 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
5185 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
5186 deeper part of the tree.
5187
5188 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
5189 @subsubsection Column attributes
5190 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
5191 definition looks like this:
5192
5193 @example
5194 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
5195 @end example
5196
5197 @noindent
5198 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5199 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5200
5201 @example
5202 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5203 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5204 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5205 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5206 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5207 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5208 @r{name is used.}
5209 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5210 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5211 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5212 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5213 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5214 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5215 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5216 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5217 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5218 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5219 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5220 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5221 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5222 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5223 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5224 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5225 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5226 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5227 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5228 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5229 @end example
5230
5231 @noindent
5232 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5233 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5234 same summary information.
5235
5236 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5237 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5238 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5239 5--6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5240 1--10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5241 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5242
5243 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5244 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5245 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5246 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5247 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5248 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5249 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5250 full job more realistically, at 10--15 days.
5251
5252 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5253 values.
5254
5255 @example
5256 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5257 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T
5258 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5259 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5260 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5261 @end example
5262
5263 @noindent
5264 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5265 item itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the
5266 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5267 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5268 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5269 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5270 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5271 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5272 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5273 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5274 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5275 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5276 @samp{CLOCKSUM} and @samp{CLOCKSUM_T} columns are special, they lists the
5277 sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, either for all clocks or just for
5278 today.
5279
5280 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5281 @subsection Using column view
5282
5283 @table @kbd
5284 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5285 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5286 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5287 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5288 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5289 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5290 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5291 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5292 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5293 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5294 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5295 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5296 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5297 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5298 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5299 Same as @kbd{r}.
5300 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5301 Exit column view.
5302 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5303 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5304 Move through the column view from field to field.
5305 @kindex S-@key{left}
5306 @kindex S-@key{right}
5307 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5308 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5309 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5310 @item 1..9,0
5311 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5312 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5313 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5314 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5315 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5316 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5317 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5318 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5319 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5320 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5321 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5322 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5323 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5324 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5325 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5326 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5327 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5328 current column view.
5329 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5330 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5331 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5332 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5333 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5334 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5335 Delete the current column.
5336 @end table
5337
5338 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5339 @subsection Capturing column view
5340
5341 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5342 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5343 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5344 of this block looks like this:
5345
5346 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5347 @example
5348 * The column view
5349 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5350
5351 #+END:
5352 @end example
5353
5354 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5355
5356 @table @code
5357 @item :id
5358 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5359 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5360 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5361 capture, you can use 4 values:
5362 @cindex property, ID
5363 @example
5364 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5365 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5366 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5367 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5368 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5369 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5370 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5371 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5372 @end example
5373 @item :hlines
5374 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5375 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5376 @item :vlines
5377 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5378 @item :maxlevel
5379 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5380 @item :skip-empty-rows
5381 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5382 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5383
5384 @end table
5385
5386 @noindent
5387 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5388
5389 @table @kbd
5390 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5391 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5392 for the scope or ID of the view.
5393 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5394 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5395 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5396 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5397 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5398 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5399 blocks in a buffer.
5400 @end table
5401
5402 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5403 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5404 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5405 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5406
5407 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5408 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5409 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5410 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5411 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5412 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5413 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5414
5415 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5416 @section The Property API
5417 @cindex properties, API
5418 @cindex API, for properties
5419
5420 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5421 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5422 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5423 property API}.
5424
5425 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5426 @chapter Dates and times
5427 @cindex dates
5428 @cindex times
5429 @cindex timestamp
5430 @cindex date stamp
5431
5432 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5433 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5434 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
5435 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5436 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
5437 is used in a much wider sense.
5438
5439 @menu
5440 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5441 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5442 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5443 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5444 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5445 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5446 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5447 @end menu
5448
5449
5450 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5451 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5452 @cindex timestamps
5453 @cindex ranges, time
5454 @cindex date stamps
5455 @cindex deadlines
5456 @cindex scheduling
5457
5458 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5459 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>}@footnote{In this
5460 simplest form, the day name is optional when you type the date yourself.
5461 However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will add that day name, for
5462 reading convenience.} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16
5463 Tue 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601
5464 date/time format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time
5465 format}.}. A timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org
5466 tree entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the
5467 agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5468
5469 @table @var
5470 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5471 @cindex timestamp
5472 @cindex appointment
5473 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5474 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5475 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5476 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5477
5478 @example
5479 * Meet Peter at the movies
5480 <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5481 * Discussion on climate change
5482 <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5483 @end example
5484
5485 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5486 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5487 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5488 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5489 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5490 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5491
5492 @example
5493 * Pick up Sam at school
5494 <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5495 @end example
5496
5497 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5498 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the special
5499 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5500 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5501 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5502 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5503 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5504 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5505 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5506 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users
5507 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5508 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5509 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5510 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For
5511 example with optional time
5512
5513 @example
5514 * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5515 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5516 @end example
5517
5518 @item Time/Date range
5519 @cindex timerange
5520 @cindex date range
5521 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5522 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5523 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5524
5525 @example
5526 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5527 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5528 @end example
5529
5530 @item Inactive timestamp
5531 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5532 @cindex inactive timestamp
5533 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5534 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5535 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5536
5537 @example
5538 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time
5539 [2006-11-01 Wed]
5540 @end example
5541
5542 @end table
5543
5544 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5545 @section Creating timestamps
5546 @cindex creating timestamps
5547 @cindex timestamps, creating
5548
5549 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5550 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5551 format.
5552
5553 @table @kbd
5554 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5555 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5556 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5557 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5558 succession, a time range is inserted.
5559 @c
5560 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5561 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5562 an agenda entry.
5563 @c
5564 @kindex C-u C-c .
5565 @kindex C-u C-c !
5566 @item C-u C-c .
5567 @itemx C-u C-c !
5568 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5569 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5570 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5571 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5572 @c
5573 @orgkey{C-c C-c}
5574 Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong.
5575 @c
5576 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5577 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5578 @c
5579 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5580 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5581 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5582 instead.
5583 @c
5584 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5585 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5586 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5587 @c
5588 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5589 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5590 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5591 @c
5592 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5593 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5594 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5595 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5596 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5597 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5598 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5599 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5600 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5601 @c
5602 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5603 @cindex evaluate time range
5604 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5605 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5606 the following column).
5607 @end table
5608
5609
5610 @menu
5611 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5612 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5613 @end menu
5614
5615 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5616 @subsection The date/time prompt
5617 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5618 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5619
5620 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5621 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5622 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5623 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5624 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5625 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5626 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5627 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5628 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5629 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5630 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5631 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5632 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5633 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5634 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5635 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5636 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5637 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5638
5639 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5640 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5641 in @b{bold}.
5642
5643 @example
5644 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5645 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5646 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5647 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5648 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5649 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5650 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5651 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5652 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5653 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5654 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5655 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5656 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5657 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5658 @end example
5659
5660 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5661 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5662 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5663 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5664 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5665 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5666 the Nth such day, e.g.:
5667
5668 @example
5669 +0 @result{} today
5670 . @result{} today
5671 +4d @result{} four days from today
5672 +4 @result{} same as above
5673 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5674 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5675 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5676 @end example
5677
5678 @vindex parse-time-months
5679 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5680 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5681 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5682 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5683
5684 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5685 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5686 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5687 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5688 read the docstring of the variable
5689 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5690
5691 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5692 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5693 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5694 case, e.g.:
5695
5696 @example
5697 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5698 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5699 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5700 @end example
5701
5702 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5703 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5704 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5705 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5706 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5707 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5708 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5709 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5710 from the minibuffer:
5711
5712 @kindex <
5713 @kindex >
5714 @kindex M-v
5715 @kindex C-v
5716 @kindex mouse-1
5717 @kindex S-@key{right}
5718 @kindex S-@key{left}
5719 @kindex S-@key{down}
5720 @kindex S-@key{up}
5721 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5722 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5723 @kindex @key{RET}
5724 @example
5725 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5726 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5727 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5728 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5729 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5730 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5731 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5732 @end example
5733
5734 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5735 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5736 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5737 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5738 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5739 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5740 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5741
5742 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5743 @subsection Custom time format
5744 @cindex custom date/time format
5745 @cindex time format, custom
5746 @cindex date format, custom
5747
5748 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5749 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5750 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5751 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5752 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5753 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5754 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5755
5756 @table @kbd
5757 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5758 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5759 @end table
5760
5761 @noindent
5762 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5763 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5764 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5765 following consequences:
5766 @itemize @bullet
5767 @item
5768 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5769 after.
5770 @item
5771 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5772 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5773 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5774 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5775 time will be changed by one minute.
5776 @item
5777 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5778 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5779 @item
5780 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5781 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5782 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5783 @item
5784 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5785 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5786 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5787 @end itemize
5788
5789
5790 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5791 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5792
5793 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5794
5795 @table @var
5796 @item DEADLINE
5797 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5798
5799 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5800 to be finished on that date.
5801
5802 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5803 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5804 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5805 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5806 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5807 until the entry is marked DONE@. An example:
5808
5809 @example
5810 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5811 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5812 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5813 @end example
5814
5815 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5816 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5817 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5818
5819 @item SCHEDULED
5820 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5821
5822 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5823 date.
5824
5825 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5826 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5827 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE@. If you don't like
5828 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5829 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5830 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.,
5831 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5832
5833 @example
5834 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5835 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5836 @end example
5837
5838 @noindent
5839 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5840 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5841 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5842 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5843 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5844 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5845 want to start working on an action item.
5846 @end table
5847
5848 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5849 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5850 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5851 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5852 @c
5853 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5854 @c
5855 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5856 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5857 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5858 sexp entry matches.
5859
5860 @menu
5861 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5862 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5863 @end menu
5864
5865 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5866 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5867
5868 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5869 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5870 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5871 an item:
5872
5873 @table @kbd
5874 @c
5875 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5876 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5877 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5878 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5879 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5880 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5881 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5882 deadline.
5883
5884 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5885 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5886 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5887 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5888 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5889 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5890 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5891 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5892 scheduling time.
5893 @c
5894 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5895 @kindex k a
5896 @kindex k s
5897 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5898 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5899 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5900 schedule the marked item.
5901 @c
5902 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5903 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5904 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5905 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5906 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5907 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5908 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5909 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5910 @c
5911 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5912 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5913 @c
5914 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5915 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5916 @end table
5917
5918 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5919 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set
5920 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5921 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5922
5923 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5924 @subsection Repeated tasks
5925 @cindex tasks, repeated
5926 @cindex repeated tasks
5927
5928 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5929 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5930 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5931 @example
5932 ** TODO Pay the rent
5933 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5934 @end example
5935 @noindent
5936 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5937 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5938 from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily and hourly repeat
5939 cookies by using the @code{y/w/m/d/h} letters. If you need both a repeater
5940 and a special warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater should come
5941 first and the warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5942
5943 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5944 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5945 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5946 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5947 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5948 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5949 repeated entry will not be active. Org mode deals with this in the following
5950 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5951 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5952 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5953 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5954 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5955 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5956 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5957 switch the date like this:
5958
5959 @example
5960 ** TODO Pay the rent
5961 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5962 @end example
5963
5964 @vindex org-log-repeat
5965 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5966 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5967 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5968 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5969 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5970
5971 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5972 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5973 will be visible.
5974
5975 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5976 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5977 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5978 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5979 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5980 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5981 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5982 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5983 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5984
5985 @example
5986 ** TODO Call Father
5987 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5988 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5989 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5990 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5991 and marked it done on Saturday.
5992 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5993 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5994 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5995 today.
5996 @end example
5997
5998 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5999 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
6000
6001 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
6002 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
6003 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
6004
6005
6006 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
6007 @section Clocking work time
6008 @cindex clocking time
6009 @cindex time clocking
6010
6011 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
6012 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. When
6013 you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the clock is
6014 stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It also computes
6015 the total time spent on each subtree@footnote{Clocking only works if all
6016 headings are indented with less than 30 stars. This is a hardcoded
6017 limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'.} of a project. And it remembers a
6018 history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly between a
6019 number of tasks absorbing your time.
6020
6021 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
6022 @lisp
6023 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
6024 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
6025 @end lisp
6026 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
6027 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
6028 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
6029 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
6030 what to do with it.
6031
6032 @menu
6033 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
6034 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
6035 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
6036 @end menu
6037
6038 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
6039 @subsection Clocking commands
6040
6041 @table @kbd
6042 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
6043 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
6044 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6045 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
6046 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
6047 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
6048 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
6049 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
6050 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
6051 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
6052 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
6053 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6054 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
6055 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task;
6056 the default task will then always be available with letter @kbd{d} when
6057 selecting a clocking task. With three @kbd{C-u C-u C-u} prefixes, force
6058 continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock stopped.@*
6059 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
6060 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
6061 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
6062 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
6063 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
6064 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
6065 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
6066 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
6067 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
6068 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
6069 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
6070 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
6071 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
6072 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
6073 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
6074 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
6075 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
6076 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
6077 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
6078 @c
6079 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
6080 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
6081 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
6082 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
6083 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
6084 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
6085 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
6086 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
6087 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
6088 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-in-last}
6089 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6090 Reclock the last clocked task. With one @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
6091 select the task from the clock history. With two @kbd{C-u} prefixes,
6092 force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock
6093 stopped.
6094 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6095 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
6096 @kindex C-c C-y
6097 @kindex C-c C-c
6098 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
6099 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
6100 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
6101 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
6102 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
6103 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the
6104 clock duration keeps the same.
6105 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{up/down},org-timestamp-up/down}
6106 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and
6107 the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same duration.
6108 For example, if you hit @kbd{S-M-@key{up}} to increase a clocked-out timestamp
6109 by five minutes, then the clocked-in timestamp of the next clock will be
6110 increased by five minutes.
6111 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
6112 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
6113 if it is running in this same item.
6114 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-q,org-clock-cancel}
6115 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
6116 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
6117 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
6118 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
6119 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
6120 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
6121 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
6122 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
6123 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
6124 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
6125 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
6126 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
6127 @kbd{C-c C-c}.
6128 @end table
6129
6130 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
6131 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
6132 worked on or closed during a day.
6133
6134 @strong{Important:} note that both @code{org-clock-out} and
6135 @code{org-clock-in-last} can have a global keybinding and will not
6136 modify the window disposition.
6137
6138 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
6139 @subsection The clock table
6140 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
6141 @cindex report, of clocked time
6142
6143 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
6144 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
6145 formatted as one or several Org tables.
6146
6147 @table @kbd
6148 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
6149 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
6150 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
6151 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
6152 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
6153 update it. The clock table always includes also trees with
6154 @code{:ARCHIVE:} tag.
6155 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
6156 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
6157 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
6158 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
6159 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
6160 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
6161 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
6162 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
6163 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
6164 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
6165 @end table
6166
6167
6168 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
6169 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
6170
6171 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
6172 @example
6173 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
6174 #+END: clocktable
6175 @end example
6176 @noindent
6177 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
6178 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
6179 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
6180 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
6181
6182 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
6183 be selected:
6184 @example
6185 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
6186 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
6187 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
6188 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
6189 file @r{the full current buffer}
6190 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
6191 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
6192 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
6193 agenda @r{all agenda files}
6194 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
6195 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
6196 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
6197 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
6198 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
6199 @r{these formats:}
6200 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
6201 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
6202 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
6203 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
6204 2007 @r{the year 2007}
6205 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
6206 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
6207 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
6208 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
6209 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
6210 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
6211 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
6212 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
6213 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
6214 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
6215 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
6216 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
6217 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
6218 @end example
6219
6220 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
6221 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
6222 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
6223 @example
6224 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
6225 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
6226 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
6227 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
6228 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
6229 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
6230 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
6231 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
6232 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6233 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6234 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6235 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6236 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6237 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6238 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6239 @r{property will get its own column.}
6240 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6241 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6242 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6243 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6244 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6245 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6246 @end example
6247 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6248 day, you could write
6249 @example
6250 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6251 #+END: clocktable
6252 @end example
6253 @noindent
6254 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6255 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6256 only to fit it into the manual.}
6257 @example
6258 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6259 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6260 #+END: clocktable
6261 @end example
6262 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6263 @example
6264 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6265 #+END: clocktable
6266 @end example
6267 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6268 would be
6269 @example
6270 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6271 #+END: clocktable
6272 @end example
6273
6274 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6275 @subsection Resolving idle time and continuous clocking
6276
6277 @subsubheading Resolving idle time
6278 @cindex resolve idle time
6279
6280 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6281 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6282 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6283 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6284 applying it to another one.
6285
6286 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6287 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6288 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6289 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6290 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6291 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6292 @code{contrib/scripts} directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same
6293 general treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs
6294 idle time only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will
6295 be a question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle
6296 time has passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a
6297 set of choices to correct the discrepancy:
6298
6299 @table @kbd
6300 @item k
6301 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6302 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6303 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6304 @item K
6305 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6306 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6307 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6308 @item s
6309 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6310 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6311 @item S
6312 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6313 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6314 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6315 @item C
6316 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6317 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6318 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6319 log with an empty entry.
6320 @end table
6321
6322 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6323 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6324 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6325 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6326 the next task you clock in on.
6327
6328 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6329 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6330 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6331 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6332 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6333
6334 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6335 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6336 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6337 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6338 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6339 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6340
6341 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6342 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks RET} (or @kbd{C-c C-x C-z}).
6343
6344 @subsubheading Continuous clocking
6345 @cindex continuous clocking
6346 @vindex org-clock-continuously
6347
6348 You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the
6349 previous task. To enable this systematically, set @code{org-clock-continuously}
6350 to @code{t}. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves the clock-out time of the
6351 last clocked entry for this session, and start the new clock from there.
6352
6353 If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix arguments
6354 with @code{org-clock-in} and two @kbd{C-u C-u} with @code{org-clock-in-last}.
6355
6356 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6357 @section Effort estimates
6358 @cindex effort estimates
6359
6360 @cindex property, Effort
6361 @vindex org-effort-property
6362 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6363 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6364 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6365 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6366 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6367 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6368 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6369 for an entry with the following commands:
6370
6371 @table @kbd
6372 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6373 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6374 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6375 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6376 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6377 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6378 @end table
6379
6380 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6381 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6382 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6383 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6384 buffer you can use
6385
6386 @example
6387 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6388 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6389 @end example
6390
6391 @noindent
6392 @vindex org-global-properties
6393 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6394 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6395 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6396 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6397 setup may be advised.
6398
6399 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6400 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6401 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6402 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6403
6404 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6405 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6406 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6407 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6408 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6409 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6410 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6411 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6412 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6413
6414 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6415 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6416 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6417 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6418
6419 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6420 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6421 @cindex relative timer
6422
6423 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6424 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6425 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6426
6427 @table @kbd
6428 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6429 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6430 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6431 restarted.
6432 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6433 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6434 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6435 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6436 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6437 new timer items.
6438 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6439 @kindex C-c C-x ,
6440 @item C-c C-x ,
6441 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6442 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6443 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6444 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6445 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
6446 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6447 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6448 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6449 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6450 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6451 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6452 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6453 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6454 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6455 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6456 not started at exactly the right moment.
6457 @end table
6458
6459 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6460 @section Countdown timer
6461 @cindex Countdown timer
6462 @kindex C-c C-x ;
6463 @kindex ;
6464
6465 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org mode buffer runs a countdown
6466 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everywhere else.
6467
6468 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6469 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6470 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6471 default value.
6472
6473 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6474 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6475 @cindex capture
6476
6477 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6478 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6479 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6480 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6481 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6482 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6483
6484 @menu
6485 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6486 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6487 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6488 * Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6489 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6490 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6491 @end menu
6492
6493 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6494 @section Capture
6495 @cindex capture
6496
6497 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6498 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6499 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org mode for
6500 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6501 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6502
6503 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6504 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6505 @example
6506 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6507 @end example
6508 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6509 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6510 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6511 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6512
6513 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6514 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6515 does enhance it with templates and more.
6516
6517 @menu
6518 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6519 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6520 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6521 @end menu
6522
6523 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6524 @subsection Setting up capture
6525
6526 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6527 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6528 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6529
6530 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6531 @example
6532 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6533 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6534 @end example
6535
6536 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6537 @subsection Using capture
6538
6539 @table @kbd
6540 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6541 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6542 not active by default; you need to install it. If you have templates
6543 @cindex date tree
6544 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6545 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6546 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6547 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6548
6549 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6550 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6551 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6552 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6553 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6554
6555 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6556 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6557 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6558 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6559 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6560 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6561 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6562
6563 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6564 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6565
6566 @end table
6567
6568 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6569 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6570 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6571 rather than to the current date.
6572
6573 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6574 prefix commands:
6575
6576 @table @kbd
6577 @orgkey{C-u C-c c}
6578 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6579 template in the usual way.
6580 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6581 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6582 @end table
6583
6584 @vindex org-capture-bookmark
6585 @cindex org-capture-last-stored
6586 You can also jump to the bookmark @code{org-capture-last-stored}, which will
6587 automatically be created unless you set @code{org-capture-bookmark} to
6588 @code{nil}.
6589
6590 To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call @code{org-capture} with
6591 a @code{C-0} prefix argument.
6592
6593 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6594 @subsection Capture templates
6595 @cindex templates, for Capture
6596
6597 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6598 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6599 through the customize interface.
6600
6601 @table @kbd
6602 @orgkey{C-c c C}
6603 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6604 @end table
6605
6606 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6607 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6608 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6609 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6610 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6611 would look like:
6612
6613 @example
6614 (setq org-capture-templates
6615 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6616 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6617 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6618 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6619 @end example
6620
6621 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6622 for you like this:
6623 @example
6624 * TODO
6625 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6626 @end example
6627
6628 @noindent
6629 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6630 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6631 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6632 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6633 place where you started the capture process.
6634
6635 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6636 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6637 like this:
6638
6639 @lisp
6640 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6641 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6642 @end lisp
6643
6644 @menu
6645 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6646 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6647 * Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context
6648 @end menu
6649
6650 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6651 @subsubsection Template elements
6652
6653 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6654 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6655
6656 @table @var
6657 @item keys
6658 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6659 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6660 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6661 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6662 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6663 prefix key, for example
6664 @example
6665 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6666 @end example
6667 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6668 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6669
6670 @item description
6671 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6672 selection.
6673
6674 @item type
6675 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6676 @table @code
6677 @item entry
6678 An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6679 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org mode file.
6680 @item item
6681 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6682 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6683 @item checkitem
6684 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6685 default template.
6686 @item table-line
6687 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6688 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6689 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6690 @item plain
6691 Text to be inserted as it is.
6692 @end table
6693
6694 @item target
6695 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6696 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org mode
6697 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6698 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6699 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6700 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6701 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6702
6703 Valid values are:
6704 @table @code
6705 @item (file "path/to/file")
6706 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6707
6708 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6709 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6710
6711 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6712 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6713
6714 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6715 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6716
6717 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6718 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6719
6720 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6721 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6722
6723 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6724 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6725
6726 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6727 A function to find the right location in the file.
6728
6729 @item (clock)
6730 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6731
6732 @item (function function-finding-location)
6733 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6734 file and location.
6735 @end table
6736
6737 @item template
6738 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6739 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6740 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6741 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6742 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6743 more details.
6744
6745 @item properties
6746 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6747 Recognized properties are:
6748 @table @code
6749 @item :prepend
6750 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6751 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6752 Setting this property will change that.
6753
6754 @item :immediate-finish
6755 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6756 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6757 information that can be added automatically.
6758
6759 @item :empty-lines
6760 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6761 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6762
6763 @item :clock-in
6764 Start the clock in this item.
6765
6766 @item :clock-keep
6767 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6768
6769 @item :clock-resume
6770 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6771 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6772 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6773 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6774
6775 @item :unnarrowed
6776 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6777 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6778
6779 @item :table-line-pos
6780 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6781 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6782 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6783 line.
6784
6785 @item :kill-buffer
6786 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6787 buffer again after capture is completed.
6788 @end table
6789 @end table
6790
6791 @node Template expansion, Templates in contexts, Template elements, Capture templates
6792 @subsubsection Template expansion
6793
6794 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6795 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6796 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6797
6798 @smallexample
6799 %[@var{file}] @r{Insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6800 %(@var{sexp}) @r{Evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6801 @r{The sexp must return a string.}
6802 %<...> @r{The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6803 %t @r{Timestamp, date only.}
6804 %T @r{Timestamp, with date and time.}
6805 %u, %U @r{Like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6806 %i @r{Initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6807 @r{region is active.}
6808 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6809 %a @r{Annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6810 %A @r{Like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6811 %l @r{Like %a, but only insert the literal link.}
6812 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6813 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6814 %k @r{Title of the currently clocked task.}
6815 %K @r{Link to the currently clocked task.}
6816 %n @r{User name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6817 %f @r{File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6818 %F @r{Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6819 %:keyword @r{Specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6820 %^g @r{Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6821 %^G @r{Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6822 %^t @r{Like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6823 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6824 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6825 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6826 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6827 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6828 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6829 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6830 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6831 %\n @r{Insert the text entered at the nth %^@{@var{prompt}@}, where @code{n} is}
6832 @r{a number, starting from 1.}
6833 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6834 @end smallexample
6835
6836 @noindent
6837 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6838 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6839 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6840 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6841 similar way.}:
6842
6843 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6844 @smallexample
6845 Link type | Available keywords
6846 ---------------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6847 bbdb | %:name %:company
6848 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6849 vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6850 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6851 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6852 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6853 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6854 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6855 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6856 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6857 w3, w3m | %:url
6858 info | %:file %:node
6859 calendar | %:date
6860 @end smallexample
6861
6862 @noindent
6863 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6864
6865 @smallexample
6866 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 @node Templates in contexts, , Template expansion, Capture templates
6870 @subsubsection Templates in contexts
6871
6872 @vindex org-capture-templates-contexts
6873 To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a specific
6874 context, you can customize @var{org-capture-templates-contexts}. Let's say
6875 for example that you have a capture template @code{"p"} for storing Gnus
6876 emails containing patches. Then you would configure this option like this:
6877
6878 @example
6879 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6880 '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6881 @end example
6882
6883 You can also tell that the command key @code{"p"} should refer to another
6884 template. In that case, add this command key like this:
6885
6886 @example
6887 (setq org-capture-templates-contexts
6888 '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
6889 @end example
6890
6891 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
6892
6893 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6894 @section Attachments
6895 @cindex attachments
6896
6897 @vindex org-attach-directory
6898 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6899 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6900 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6901 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6902 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6903 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6904 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6905 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6906 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6907 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6908 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6909 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6910 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6911
6912 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6913 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6914 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6915 directory.
6916
6917 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6918
6919 @table @kbd
6920
6921 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6922 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6923 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6924 to select a command:
6925
6926 @table @kbd
6927 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6928 @vindex org-attach-method
6929 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6930 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6931 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6932
6933 @kindex C-c C-a c
6934 @kindex C-c C-a m
6935 @kindex C-c C-a l
6936 @item c/m/l
6937 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6938 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6939
6940 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6941 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6942
6943 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6944 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6945 attachments yourself.
6946
6947 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6948 @vindex org-file-apps
6949 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6950 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6951 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6952 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6953
6954 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6955 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6956
6957 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6958 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6959
6960 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6961 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6962
6963 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6964 Select and delete a single attachment.
6965
6966 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6967 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6968 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6969
6970 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6971 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6972 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6973 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6974
6975 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6976 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6977 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6978 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6979 @end table
6980 @end table
6981
6982 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6983 @section RSS feeds
6984 @cindex RSS feeds
6985 @cindex Atom feeds
6986
6987 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6988 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6989 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6990 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6991 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6992 information. Here is just an example:
6993
6994 @example
6995 (setq org-feed-alist
6996 '(("Slashdot"
6997 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6998 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6999 @end example
7000
7001 @noindent
7002 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
7003 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
7004 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
7005 the following command is used:
7006
7007 @table @kbd
7008 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
7009 @item C-c C-x g
7010 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
7011 them.
7012 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
7013 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
7014 @end table
7015
7016 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
7017 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
7018 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
7019 list of drawers in that file:
7020
7021 @example
7022 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
7023 @end example
7024
7025 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
7026 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
7027
7028 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
7029 @section Protocols for external access
7030 @cindex protocols, for external access
7031 @cindex emacsserver
7032
7033 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
7034 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
7035 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
7036 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
7037 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
7038 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
7039 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
7040 documentation and setup instructions.
7041
7042 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
7043 @section Refiling notes
7044 @cindex refiling notes
7045
7046 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
7047 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
7048 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
7049 process, you can use the following special command:
7050
7051 @table @kbd
7052 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
7053 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
7054 @vindex org-refile-targets
7055 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
7056 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
7057 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
7058 @vindex org-log-refile
7059 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
7060 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
7061 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
7062 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
7063 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
7064 last subitem.@*
7065 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
7066 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
7067 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
7068 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
7069 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
7070 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
7071 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
7072 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
7073 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
7074 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
7075 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
7076 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
7077 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
7078 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
7079 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
7080 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
7081 @item C-2 C-c C-w
7082 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
7083 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
7084 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
7085 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
7086 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
7087 @end table
7088
7089 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
7090 @section Archiving
7091 @cindex archiving
7092
7093 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
7094 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
7095 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
7096 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
7097
7098 @table @kbd
7099 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
7100 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7101 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
7102 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
7103 @end table
7104
7105 @menu
7106 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
7107 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
7108 @end menu
7109
7110 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
7111 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
7112 @cindex external archiving
7113
7114 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
7115 the archive file.
7116
7117 @table @kbd
7118 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
7119 @vindex org-archive-location
7120 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
7121 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
7122 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
7123 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
7124 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
7125 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
7126 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
7127 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
7128 @end table
7129
7130 @cindex archive locations
7131 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
7132 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
7133 current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived
7134 items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file.
7135 For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading,
7136 see the documentation string of the variable
7137 @code{org-archive-location}.
7138
7139 There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for
7140 example@footnote{For backward compatibility, the following also works:
7141 If there are several such lines in a file, each specifies the archive
7142 location for the text below it. The first such line also applies to any
7143 text before its definition. However, using this method is
7144 @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible with the outline
7145 structure of the document. The correct method for setting multiple
7146 archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
7147
7148 @cindex #+ARCHIVE
7149 @example
7150 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
7151 @end example
7152
7153 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
7154 @noindent
7155 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
7156 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
7157 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
7158
7159 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
7160 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
7161 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
7162 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
7163 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
7164 added.
7165
7166
7167 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
7168 @subsection Internal archiving
7169
7170 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
7171 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
7172
7173 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
7174 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
7175 @itemize @minus
7176 @item
7177 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
7178 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
7179 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
7180 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
7181 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
7182 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
7183 @item
7184 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
7185 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
7186 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
7187 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
7188 @item
7189 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
7190 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
7191 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
7192 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
7193 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
7194 temporarily included.
7195 @item
7196 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
7197 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
7198 is. Configure the details using the variable
7199 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
7200 @item
7201 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
7202 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
7203 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
7204 @end itemize
7205
7206 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
7207
7208 @table @kbd
7209 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
7210 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
7211 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
7212 hidden.
7213 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
7214 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
7215 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
7216 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
7217 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
7218 level 1 trees will be checked.
7219 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
7220 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
7221 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7222 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
7223 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
7224 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
7225 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
7226 outline.
7227 @end table
7228
7229
7230 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
7231 @chapter Agenda views
7232 @cindex agenda views
7233
7234 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
7235 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
7236 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
7237 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
7238 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
7239
7240 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
7241 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
7242
7243 @itemize @bullet
7244 @item
7245 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
7246 for specific dates,
7247 @item
7248 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
7249 action items,
7250 @item
7251 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
7252 TODO state associated with them,
7253 @item
7254 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
7255 in time-sorted view,
7256 @item
7257 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
7258 that contain specified keywords,
7259 @item
7260 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
7261 along, and
7262 @item
7263 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
7264 views.
7265 @end itemize
7266
7267 @noindent
7268 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
7269 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
7270 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
7271 edit these files remotely.
7272
7273 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
7274 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
7275 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
7276 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
7277 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
7278 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
7279
7280 @menu
7281 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
7282 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
7283 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
7284 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
7285 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7286 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7287 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7288 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7289 @end menu
7290
7291 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7292 @section Agenda files
7293 @cindex agenda files
7294 @cindex files for agenda
7295
7296 @vindex org-agenda-files
7297 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7298 files}, the files listed in the variable
7299 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7300 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7301 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7302 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7303 of the list.
7304
7305 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7306 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7307 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7308 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7309 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7310 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7311
7312 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7313 @table @kbd
7314 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7315 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7316 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7317 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7318 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7319 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7320 @kindex C-,
7321 @cindex cycling, of agenda files
7322 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7323 @itemx C-,
7324 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7325 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7326 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7327 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7328 buffers.
7329 @end table
7330
7331 @noindent
7332 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7333 to visit any of them.
7334
7335 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7336 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7337 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7338 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7339 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7340 extended period, use the following commands:
7341
7342 @table @kbd
7343 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7344 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7345 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7346 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7347 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7348 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7349 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7350 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7351 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7352 @end table
7353
7354 @noindent
7355 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7356 the Speedbar frame:
7357 @table @kbd
7358 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7359 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7360 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7361 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7362 effect immediately.
7363 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7364 Lift the restriction.
7365 @end table
7366
7367 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7368 @section The agenda dispatcher
7369 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7370 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7371 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7372 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7373 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7374 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7375 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7376 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7377 @table @kbd
7378 @item a
7379 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7380 @item t @r{/} T
7381 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7382 @item m @r{/} M
7383 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7384 tags and properties}).
7385 @item L
7386 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7387 @item s
7388 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7389 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7390 @item /
7391 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7392 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7393 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7394 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7395 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7396 1.
7397 @item # @r{/} !
7398 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7399 @item <
7400 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7401 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7402 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7403 selecting the command.
7404 @item < <
7405 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7406 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7407 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7408 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7409 character selecting the command.
7410
7411 @item *
7412 @vindex org-agenda-sticky
7413 Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a single agenda
7414 buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the view, to make sure everything
7415 is always up to date. If you switch between views often and the build time
7416 bothers you, you can turn on sticky agenda buffers (make this the default by
7417 customizing the variable @code{org-agenda-sticky}). With sticky agendas, the
7418 dispatcher only switches to the selected view, you need to update it by hand
7419 with @kbd{r} or @kbd{g}. You can toggle sticky agenda view any time with
7420 @code{org-toggle-sticky-agenda}.
7421 @end table
7422
7423 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7424 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7425 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7426 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7427 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7428
7429 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7430 @section The built-in agenda views
7431
7432 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7433
7434 @menu
7435 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7436 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7437 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7438 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7439 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7440 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7441 @end menu
7442
7443 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7444 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7445 @cindex agenda
7446 @cindex weekly agenda
7447 @cindex daily agenda
7448
7449 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7450 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7451
7452 @table @kbd
7453 @cindex org-agenda, command
7454 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7455 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7456 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7457 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7458 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7459 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7460 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7461 @end table
7462
7463 @vindex org-agenda-span
7464 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7465 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7466 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7467 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7468 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7469 @code{year}.
7470
7471 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7472 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7473 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7474 commands}.
7475
7476 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7477 @cindex calendar integration
7478 @cindex diary integration
7479
7480 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7481 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7482 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7483 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7484 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7485 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7486 the diary.
7487
7488 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
7489 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7490
7491 @lisp
7492 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7493 @end lisp
7494
7495 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7496 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7497 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7498 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7499 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7500 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7501 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7502 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7503 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7504 between calendar and agenda.
7505
7506 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7507 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7508 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7509 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7510 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7511 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7512 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7513 will be made in the agenda:
7514
7515 @example
7516 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7517 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
7518 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7519 #+CATEGORY: Ann
7520 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7521 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7522 @end example
7523
7524 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7525 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7526 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7527
7528 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7529 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7530 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7531 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7532 following to one of your agenda files:
7533
7534 @example
7535 * Anniversaries
7536 :PROPERTIES:
7537 :CATEGORY: Anniv
7538 :END:
7539 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7540 @end example
7541
7542 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7543 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7544 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7545 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7546 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7547 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7548 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7549
7550 @example
7551 1973-06-22
7552 06-22
7553 1955-08-02 wedding
7554 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago
7555 @end example
7556
7557 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7558 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7559 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7560 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7561 in an Org or Diary file.
7562
7563 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7564 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7565 @cindex appointment reminders
7566 @cindex appointment
7567 @cindex reminders
7568
7569 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add the
7570 appointments of your agenda files, use the command @code{org-agenda-to-appt}.
7571 This command lets you filter through the list of your appointments and add
7572 only those belonging to a specific category or matching a regular expression.
7573 It also reads a @code{APPT_WARNTIME} property which will then override the
7574 value of @code{appt-message-warning-time} for this appointment. See the
7575 docstring for details.
7576
7577 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7578 @subsection The global TODO list
7579 @cindex global TODO list
7580 @cindex TODO list, global
7581
7582 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7583 collected into a single place.
7584
7585 @table @kbd
7586 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7587 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7588 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7589 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7590 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7591 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7592 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7593 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7594 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7595 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7596 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7597 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7598 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7599 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7600 @kindex r
7601 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7602 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7603 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7604 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7605 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7606 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7607 @end table
7608
7609 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7610 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7611 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7612
7613 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7614 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7615 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7616 it more compact:
7617 @itemize @minus
7618 @item
7619 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7620 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7621 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7622 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7623 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7624 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7625 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7626 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7627 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7628 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7629 TODO list.
7630 @item
7631 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7632 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7633 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7634 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7635 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7636 @end itemize
7637
7638 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7639 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7640 @cindex matching, of tags
7641 @cindex matching, of properties
7642 @cindex tags view
7643 @cindex match view
7644
7645 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7646 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7647 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7648 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7649 m}.
7650
7651 @table @kbd
7652 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7653 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7654 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7655 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7656 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7657 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7658 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7659 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7660 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7661 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7662 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7663 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7664 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7665 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7666 @ref{Tag searches}.
7667 @end table
7668
7669 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7670 commands}.
7671
7672 @subsubheading Match syntax
7673
7674 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7675 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7676 OR@. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7677 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7678 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7679 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7680 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7681 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7682 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7683
7684 @table @samp
7685 @item +work-boss
7686 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7687 @samp{:boss:}.
7688 @item work|laptop
7689 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7690 @item work|laptop+night
7691 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7692 @samp{:night:}.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7696 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7697 braces. For example,
7698 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7699 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7700
7701 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7702 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7703 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7704 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7705 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7706 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7707 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7708 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7709 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7710 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7711 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7712 DONE@. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7713 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7714 The ITEM special property cannot currently be used in tags/property
7715 searches@footnote{But @pxref{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp,
7716 ,skipping entries based on regexp}.}.
7717
7718 Here are more examples:
7719 @table @samp
7720 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7721 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7722 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7723 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7724 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7725 @end table
7726
7727 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7728 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7729
7730 @example
7731 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7732 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7733 @end example
7734
7735 @noindent
7736 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7737 @itemize @minus
7738 @item
7739 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7740 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7741 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7742 @item
7743 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7744 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7745 @item
7746 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7747 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7748 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7749 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7750 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7751 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e., without a time
7752 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7753 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7754 respectively, can be used.
7755 @item
7756 If the comparison value is enclosed
7757 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7758 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7759 match.
7760 @end itemize
7761
7762 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7763 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7764 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7765 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7766 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7767 on or after October 11, 2008.
7768
7769 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7770 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7771 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7772 again.
7773
7774 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7775 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7776 inheritance}, for details.
7777
7778 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7779 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7780 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7781 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7782 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7783 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7784 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND@.
7785 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7786 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7787 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7788 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7789 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7790
7791 @table @samp
7792 @item work/WAITING
7793 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7794 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7795 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7796 nor @samp{NEXT}
7797 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7798 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7799 @samp{NEXT}.
7800 @end table
7801
7802 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7803 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7804 @cindex timeline, single file
7805 @cindex time-sorted view
7806
7807 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
7808 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7809 to give an overview over events in a project.
7810
7811 @table @kbd
7812 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7813 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7814 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7815 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7816 @end table
7817
7818 @noindent
7819 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7820 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7821
7822 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7823 @subsection Search view
7824 @cindex search view
7825 @cindex text search
7826 @cindex searching, for text
7827
7828 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
7829 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7830
7831 @table @kbd
7832 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7833 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7834 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7835 @end table
7836 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7837 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7838 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7839 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7840 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7841 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7842 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7843 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7844 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7845 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7846 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7847
7848 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7849 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7850 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7851
7852 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7853 @subsection Stuck projects
7854 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7855
7856 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7857 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7858 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7859 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7860 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7861 projects and define next actions for them.
7862
7863 @table @kbd
7864 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7865 List projects that are stuck.
7866 @kindex C-c a !
7867 @item C-c a !
7868 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7869 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7870 project is and how to find it.
7871 @end table
7872
7873 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7874 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7875 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7876 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7877
7878 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
7879 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7880 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7881 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7882 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7883 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7884 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7885 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7886 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7887 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7888 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7889 correct customization for this is
7890
7891 @lisp
7892 (setq org-stuck-projects
7893 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7894 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
7895 @end lisp
7896
7897 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7898 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7899
7900 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7901 @section Presentation and sorting
7902 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7903
7904 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7905 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7906 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares the
7907 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7908 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7909 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7910 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7911 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7912 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7913 associated with the item.
7914
7915 @menu
7916 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7917 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7918 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7919 @end menu
7920
7921 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7922 @subsection Categories
7923
7924 @cindex category
7925 @cindex #+CATEGORY
7926 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7927 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7928 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7929 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7930 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7931 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7932 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7933 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7934 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7935 property.}:
7936
7937 @example
7938 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
7939 @end example
7940
7941 @noindent
7942 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7943 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7944 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7945 special category you want to apply as the value.
7946
7947 @noindent
7948 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7949 longer than 10 characters.
7950
7951 @noindent
7952 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7953 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7954
7955 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7956 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7957 @cindex time-of-day specification
7958
7959 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7960 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7961 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7962 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7963 @c
7964 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7965
7966 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7967 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7968 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7969 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7970
7971 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7972 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7973 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7974
7975 @example
7976 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7977 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7978 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7979 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7980 @end example
7981
7982 @cindex time grid
7983 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7984 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7985
7986 @example
7987 8:00...... ------------------
7988 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7989 10:00...... ------------------
7990 12:00...... ------------------
7991 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7992 14:00...... ------------------
7993 16:00...... ------------------
7994 18:00...... ------------------
7995 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7996 20:00...... ------------------
7997 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7998 @end example
7999
8000 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8001 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8002 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
8003 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
8004 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8005
8006 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
8007 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
8008 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
8009 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
8010 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
8011 done depends on the type of view.
8012 @itemize @bullet
8013 @item
8014 @vindex org-agenda-files
8015 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
8016 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
8017 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
8018 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
8019 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
8020 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
8021 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
8022 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
8023 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
8024 @item
8025 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
8026 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
8027 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
8028 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
8029 or scheduled date.
8030 @item
8031 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
8032 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
8033 @end itemize
8034
8035 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
8036 Sorting can be customized using the variable
8037 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
8038 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
8039
8040 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
8041 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
8042 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
8043
8044 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
8045 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
8046 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
8047 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
8048 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
8049 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
8050
8051 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
8052 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
8053
8054 @table @kbd
8055 @tsubheading{Motion}
8056 @cindex motion commands in agenda
8057 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
8058 Next line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
8059 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
8060 Previous line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
8061 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
8062 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
8063 Display the original location of the item in another window.
8064 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
8065 outline, not only the heading.
8066 @c
8067 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
8068 Display original location and recenter that window.
8069 @c
8070 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
8071 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
8072 @c
8073 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
8074 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
8075 @c
8076 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
8077 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
8078 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
8079 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
8080 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
8081 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8082 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
8083 @c
8084 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
8085 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
8086 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
8087 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
8088 previously used indirect buffer.
8089
8090 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
8091 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
8092 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
8093 will be followed without a selection prompt.
8094
8095 @tsubheading{Change display}
8096 @cindex display changing, in agenda
8097 @kindex A
8098 @item A
8099 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
8100 @c
8101 @kindex o
8102 @item o
8103 Delete other windows.
8104 @c
8105 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-agenda-day-view}
8106 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-agenda-week-view}
8107 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
8108 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-year-view}
8109 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
8110 @vindex org-agenda-span
8111 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
8112 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
8113 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
8114 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
8115 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
8116 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
8117 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
8118 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
8119 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
8120 1938--2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
8121 @code{org-agenda-span}.
8122 @c
8123 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
8124 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8125 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
8126 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
8127 @c
8128 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
8129 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
8130 @c
8131 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
8132 Go to today.
8133 @c
8134 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
8135 Prompt for a date and go there.
8136 @c
8137 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8138 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
8139 @c
8140 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
8141 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
8142 @c
8143 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
8144 @kindex v L
8145 @vindex org-log-done
8146 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
8147 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
8148 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
8149 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
8150 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
8151 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
8152 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
8153 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
8154 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
8155 @c
8156 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
8157 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
8158 agenda and timeline views.
8159 @c
8160 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
8161 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
8162 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
8163 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
8164 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
8165 press @kbd{v a} again.
8166 @c
8167 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
8168 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
8169 @vindex org-clock-report-include-clocking-task
8170 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
8171 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
8172 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
8173 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
8174 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
8175 when toggling this mode (i.e., @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
8176 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
8177 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}. See
8178 also the variable @code{org-clock-report-include-clocking-task}.
8179 @c
8180 @orgkey{v c}
8181 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
8182 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
8183 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
8184 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
8185 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
8186 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
8187 mode.
8188 @c
8189 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
8190 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
8191 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
8192 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
8193 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
8194 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
8195 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
8196 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
8197 @c
8198 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
8199 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
8200 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
8201 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
8202 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
8203 @c
8204 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
8205 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
8206 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
8207 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
8208 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
8209 keyword.
8210 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
8211 Same as @kbd{r}.
8212 @c
8213 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
8214 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
8215 IDs.
8216 @c
8217 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8218 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8219 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
8220 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
8221 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
8222 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
8223 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
8224 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
8225
8226 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
8227 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
8228 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
8229
8230 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
8231 @cindex filtering, by tag category and effort, in agenda
8232 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
8233 @cindex category filtering, in agenda
8234 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
8235 @cindex query editing, in agenda
8236
8237 @orgcmd{<,org-agenda-filter-by-category}
8238 @vindex org-agenda-category-filter-preset
8239
8240 Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the item at
8241 point. Pressing @code{<} another time will remove this filter. You can add
8242 a filter preset through the option @code{org-agenda-category-filter-preset}
8243 (see below.)
8244
8245 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
8246 @vindex org-agenda-tag-filter-preset
8247 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
8248 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
8249 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
8250 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
8251 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-tag-filter-preset} as an option. This
8252 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
8253 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
8254 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
8255 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
8256
8257 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
8258 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
8259 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
8260 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
8261 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
8262 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
8263 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
8264 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
8265 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
8266 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
8267
8268 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
8269 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
8270 efforts globally, for example
8271 @lisp
8272 (setq org-global-properties
8273 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
8274 @end lisp
8275 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
8276 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
8277 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
8278 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
8279 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0--9 are not used
8280 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
8281 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
8282 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
8283 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
8284 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
8285
8286 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
8287 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
8288 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
8289 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
8290 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
8291 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
8292 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
8293 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
8294 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
8295
8296 @lisp
8297 @group
8298 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
8299 (and (cond
8300 ((string= tag "Net")
8301 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
8302 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
8303 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
8304 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
8305 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
8306 (concat "-" tag)))
8307
8308 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
8309 @end group
8310 @end lisp
8311
8312 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
8313 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
8314 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
8315 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8316 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8317
8318 @c
8319 @kindex [
8320 @kindex ]
8321 @kindex @{
8322 @kindex @}
8323 @item [ ] @{ @}
8324 @table @i
8325 @item @r{in} search view
8326 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8327 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8328 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8329 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8330 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8331 selected.
8332 @end table
8333
8334 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8335 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8336
8337 @item 0--9
8338 Digit argument.
8339 @c
8340 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8341 @cindex remote editing, undo
8342 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8343 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8344 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8345 @c
8346 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8347 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8348 original org file.
8349 @c
8350 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8351 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8352 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8353 @c
8354 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8355 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8356 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8357 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8358 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8359 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8360 @c
8361 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8362 Refile the entry at point.
8363 @c
8364 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8365 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8366 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8367 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8368 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8369 @c
8370 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8371 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8372 @c
8373 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8374 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8375 sibling}.
8376 @c
8377 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8378 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8379 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8380 different file.
8381 @c
8382 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8383 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8384 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8385 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8386 tags of a headline occasionally.
8387 @c
8388 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8389 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8390 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8391 @c
8392 @kindex ,
8393 @item ,
8394 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8395 Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8396 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8397 @c
8398 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8399 Display weighted priority of current item.
8400 @c
8401 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8402 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8403 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8404 key for this.
8405 @c
8406 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8407 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8408 @c
8409 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8410 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8411 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8412 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8413 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8414 @c
8415 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8416 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8417 @c
8418 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8419 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8420 @c
8421 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8422 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8423 @c
8424 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8425 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8426 future. If the date is in the past, the first call to this command will move
8427 it to today.@*
8428 With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For example,
8429 @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
8430 change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the command, it will
8431 continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With a double @kbd{C-u
8432 C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes.@*
8433 The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly
8434 reflected in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8435 @c
8436 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8437 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8438 into the past.
8439 @c
8440 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8441 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8442 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8443 @c
8444 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8445 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8446 is stopped first.
8447 @c
8448 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8449 Stop the previously started clock.
8450 @c
8451 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8452 Cancel the currently running clock.
8453 @c
8454 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8455 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8456 @c
8457 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-capture}
8458 Like @code{org-capture}, but use the date at point as the default date for
8459 the capture template. See @var{org-capture-use-agenda-date} to make this
8460 the default behavior of @code{org-capture}.
8461 @cindex capturing, from agenda
8462 @vindex org-capture-use-agenda-date
8463
8464 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8465 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8466 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks
8467 @vindex org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions
8468
8469 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8470 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8471 successive entries.
8472 @c
8473 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8474 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8475 @c
8476 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8477 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8478 @c
8479 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8480 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8481 @c
8482 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8483 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8484 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8485 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8486 these special timestamps. By default, marks are removed after the bulk. If
8487 you want them to persist, set @code{org-agenda-bulk-persistent-marks} to
8488 @code{t} or hit @kbd{p} at the prompt.
8489
8490 @example
8491 * @r{Toggle persistent marks.}
8492 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8493 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8494 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8495 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8496 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8497 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8498 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8499 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8500 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8501 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8502 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8503 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8504 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8505 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8506 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8507 f @r{Apply a function@footnote{You can also create persistent custom functions through@code{org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions}.} to marked entries.}
8508 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8509 @r{entries to web.}
8510 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8511 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8512 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8513 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8514 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8515 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8516 @r{ (save-excursion}
8517 @r{ (save-restriction}
8518 @r{ (widen)}
8519 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8520 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8521 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8522 @end example
8523
8524
8525 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8526 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8527
8528 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8529 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8530 @c
8531 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8532 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
8533 date at the cursor.
8534 @c
8535 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8536 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8537 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8538 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8539 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8540 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8541 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8542 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8543 you can add the entry.
8544
8545 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org mode file,
8546 Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8547 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8548 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8549 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8550 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8551 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8552 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8553 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8554 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8555 @c
8556 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8557 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8558 @c
8559 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8560 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8561 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8562 @c
8563 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8564 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8565 calendars.
8566 @c
8567 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8568 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8569
8570 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8571 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8572 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8573
8574 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8575 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8576 @cindex exporting agenda views
8577 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8578 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8579 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8580 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8581 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8582 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8583 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8584 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8585 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8586
8587 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8588 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8589 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8590 @c
8591 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8592 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8593 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8594 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8595 visit Org files will not be removed.
8596 @end table
8597
8598
8599 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8600 @section Custom agenda views
8601 @cindex custom agenda views
8602 @cindex agenda views, custom
8603
8604 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8605 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8606 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8607 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8608
8609 @menu
8610 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8611 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8612 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8613 @end menu
8614
8615 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8616 @subsection Storing searches
8617
8618 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8619 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8620 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8621 buffer).
8622 @kindex C-c a C
8623 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8624
8625 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8626 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8627 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with Emacs
8628 Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid search
8629 types:
8630
8631 @lisp
8632 @group
8633 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8634 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8635 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8636 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8637 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8638 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8639 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8640 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8641 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8642 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8643 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8644 @end group
8645 @end lisp
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8649 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8650 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8651 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8652 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8653 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8654 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8655 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8656 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8657 therefore define:
8658
8659 @table @kbd
8660 @item C-c a w
8661 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8662 keyword
8663 @item C-c a W
8664 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8665 results as a sparse tree
8666 @item C-c a u
8667 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8668 @samp{:urgent:}
8669 @item C-c a v
8670 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8671 headlines that are also TODO items
8672 @item C-c a U
8673 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8674 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8675 @item C-c a f
8676 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8677 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8678 @item C-c a h
8679 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8680 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8681 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8682 @end table
8683
8684 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8685 @subsection Block agenda
8686 @cindex block agenda
8687 @cindex agenda, with block views
8688
8689 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8690 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8691 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8692 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8693 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8694 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8695 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8696
8697 @lisp
8698 @group
8699 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8700 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8701 ((agenda "")
8702 (tags-todo "home")
8703 (tags "garden")))
8704 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8705 ((agenda "")
8706 (tags-todo "work")
8707 (tags "office")))))
8708 @end group
8709 @end lisp
8710
8711 @noindent
8712 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8713 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8714 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8715 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8716 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8717
8718 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8719 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8720 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8721
8722 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8723 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8724 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8725 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8726 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8727 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8728 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8729
8730 @lisp
8731 @group
8732 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8733 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8734 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8735 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8736 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8737 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8738 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8739 ("N" search ""
8740 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8741 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8742 @end group
8743 @end lisp
8744
8745 @noindent
8746 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8747 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8748 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8749 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8750 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8751 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8752 to only a single file.
8753
8754 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8755 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8756 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8757 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8758 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8759 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8760 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8761 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8762 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8763 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8764 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8765
8766 @lisp
8767 @group
8768 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8769 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8770 ((agenda)
8771 (tags-todo "home")
8772 (tags "garden"
8773 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8774 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8775 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8776 ((agenda)
8777 (tags-todo "work")
8778 (tags "office")))))
8779 @end group
8780 @end lisp
8781
8782 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8783 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8784 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8785 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8786 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8787 yourself.
8788
8789 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8790 To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a specific
8791 context, you can customize @var{org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts}. Let's
8792 say for example that you have an agenda commands @code{"o"} displaying a view
8793 that you only need when reading emails. Then you would configure this option
8794 like this:
8795
8796 @example
8797 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8798 '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8799 @end example
8800
8801 You can also tell that the command key @code{"o"} should refer to another
8802 command key @code{"r"}. In that case, add this command key like this:
8803
8804 @example
8805 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts
8806 '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode"))))
8807 @end example
8808
8809 See the docstring of the variable for more information.
8810
8811 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8812 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8813 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8814
8815 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8816 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
8817 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8818 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8819 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8820 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8821 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8822
8823 @table @kbd
8824 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-agenda-write}
8825 @cindex exporting agenda views
8826 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8827 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8828 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8829 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8830 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8831 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8832 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8833 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8834
8835 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8836 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8837 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8838 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8839 @lisp
8840 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8841 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8842 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8843 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8844 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8845 @end lisp
8846 @end table
8847
8848 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8849 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8850 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8851 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8852 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8853 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8854 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8855 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8856 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8857 or absolute.
8858
8859 @lisp
8860 @group
8861 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8862 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8863 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8864 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8865 ((agenda "")
8866 (tags-todo "home")
8867 (tags "garden"))
8868 nil
8869 ("~/views/home.html"))
8870 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8871 ((agenda)
8872 (tags-todo "work")
8873 (tags "office"))
8874 nil
8875 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8876 @end group
8877 @end lisp
8878
8879 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8880 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8881 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8882 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8883 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8884 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8885 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8886 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8887
8888 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8889 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8890 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8891 files in one step:
8892
8893 @table @kbd
8894 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8895 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8896 them.
8897 @end table
8898
8899 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8900 set options for the export commands. For example:
8901
8902 @lisp
8903 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8904 '(("X" agenda ""
8905 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8906 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8907 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8908 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8909 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8910 ("theagenda.ps"))))
8911 @end lisp
8912
8913 @noindent
8914 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8915 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8916 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8917 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8918 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8919 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8920 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8921 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8922 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8923
8924 @noindent
8925 From the command line you may also use
8926 @example
8927 emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill
8928 @end example
8929 @noindent
8930 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8931 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8932 @example
8933 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8934 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
8935 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8936 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8937 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8938 -kill
8939 @end example
8940 @noindent
8941 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8942 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8943 extent.
8944
8945 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8946 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8947 more information.
8948
8949
8950 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8951 @section Using column view in the agenda
8952 @cindex column view, in agenda
8953 @cindex agenda, column view
8954
8955 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8956 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8957 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8958 collected by certain criteria.
8959
8960 @table @kbd
8961 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8962 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8963 @end table
8964
8965 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8966 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8967 This causes the following issues:
8968
8969 @enumerate
8970 @item
8971 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8972 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8973 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8974 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8975 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8976 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8977 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8978 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8979 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8980 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8981 @item
8982 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8983 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8984 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8985 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8986 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8987 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8988 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8989 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8990 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8991 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8992 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8993 some values will count double.
8994 @item
8995 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8996 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8997 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8998 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8999 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
9000 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
9001 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
9002 the agenda).
9003
9004 @item
9005 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM_T
9006 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM_T}, that is
9007 always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly agenda,
9008 the clocksum listed in column view only originates from today. This lets
9009 you compare the time you spent on a task for today, with the time already
9010 spent (via @code{CLOCKSUM}) and with the planned total effort for it.
9011 @end enumerate
9012
9013
9014 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
9015 @chapter Markup for rich export
9016
9017 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
9018 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
9019 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
9020 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
9021 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer.
9022
9023 @menu
9024 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
9025 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
9026 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
9027 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
9028 * Index entries:: Making an index
9029 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
9030 * Embedded @LaTeX{}:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
9031 @end menu
9032
9033 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
9034 @section Structural markup elements
9035
9036 @menu
9037 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
9038 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
9039 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
9040 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
9041 * Lists:: Lists
9042 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
9043 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
9044 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
9045 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
9046 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
9047 @end menu
9048
9049 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
9050 @subheading Document title
9051 @cindex document title, markup rules
9052
9053 @noindent
9054 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
9055
9056 @cindex #+TITLE
9057 @example
9058 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
9059 @end example
9060
9061 @noindent
9062 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
9063 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
9064 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
9065 title will be the file name without extension.
9066
9067 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
9068 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
9069 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
9070 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
9071
9072 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
9073 @subheading Headings and sections
9074 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
9075
9076 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
9077 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
9078 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
9079 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
9080 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
9081 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
9082 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
9083 per-file basis with a line
9084
9085 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9086 @example
9087 #+OPTIONS: H:4
9088 @end example
9089
9090 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
9091 @subheading Table of contents
9092 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
9093
9094 @vindex org-export-with-toc
9095 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
9096 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
9097 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
9098 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
9099 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
9100 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
9101 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
9102
9103 @example
9104 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
9105 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
9106 @end example
9107
9108 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
9109 @subheading Text before the first headline
9110 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
9111 @cindex #+TEXT
9112
9113 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
9114 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
9115 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
9116 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
9117
9118 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
9119 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
9120 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
9121 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
9122 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
9123 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
9124
9125 @noindent
9126 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
9127 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
9128
9129 @example
9130 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
9131 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
9132 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
9133 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
9134 @end example
9135
9136 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
9137 @subheading Lists
9138 @cindex lists, markup rules
9139
9140 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
9141 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
9142 description lists.
9143
9144 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
9145 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
9146 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
9147
9148 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
9149 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
9150
9151 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
9152 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
9153
9154 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
9155 @example
9156 #+BEGIN_VERSE
9157 Great clouds overhead
9158 Tiny black birds rise and fall
9159 Snow covers Emacs
9160
9161 -- AlexSchroeder
9162 #+END_VERSE
9163 @end example
9164
9165 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
9166 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
9167 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
9168
9169 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9170 @example
9171 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
9172 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
9173 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
9174 #+END_QUOTE
9175 @end example
9176
9177 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
9178 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
9179 @example
9180 #+BEGIN_CENTER
9181 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
9182 but not any simpler
9183 #+END_CENTER
9184 @end example
9185
9186
9187 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
9188 @subheading Footnote markup
9189 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
9190 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9191
9192 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
9193 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
9194 multiple footnotes side by side.
9195
9196 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
9197 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
9198
9199 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
9200 @cindex bold text, markup rules
9201 @cindex italic text, markup rules
9202 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
9203 @cindex code text, markup rules
9204 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
9205 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
9206 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
9207 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
9208 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
9209
9210 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
9211 @subheading Horizontal rules
9212 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
9213 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
9214 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
9215
9216 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
9217 @subheading Comment lines
9218 @cindex comment lines
9219 @cindex exporting, not
9220 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
9221
9222 Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one
9223 @samp{#} and a whitespace are treated as comments and will never be exported.
9224 Also entire subtrees starting with the word @samp{COMMENT} will never be
9225 exported. Finally, regions surrounded by @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT}
9226 ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
9227
9228 @table @kbd
9229 @kindex C-c ;
9230 @item C-c ;
9231 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
9232 @end table
9233
9234
9235 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
9236 @section Images and Tables
9237
9238 @cindex tables, markup rules
9239 @cindex #+CAPTION
9240 @cindex #+LABEL
9241 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
9242 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
9243 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
9244 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
9245 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
9246 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
9247
9248 @example
9249 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
9250 #+LABEL: tab:basic-data
9251 | ... | ...|
9252 |-----|----|
9253 @end example
9254
9255 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
9256 @example
9257 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
9258 @end example
9259
9260 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
9261 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
9262 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
9263 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
9264 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
9265 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
9266 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
9267
9268 @example
9269 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
9270 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9271 [[./img/a.jpg]]
9272 @end example
9273
9274 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
9275 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
9276 information.
9277
9278 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
9279
9280 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
9281 @section Literal examples
9282 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
9283 @cindex code line references, markup rules
9284
9285 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
9286 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
9287 for source code and similar examples.
9288 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9289
9290 @example
9291 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
9292 Some example from a text file.
9293 #+END_EXAMPLE
9294 @end example
9295
9296 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
9297 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
9298 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
9299 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
9300 whitespace before the colon:
9301
9302 @example
9303 Here is an example
9304 : Some example from a text file.
9305 @end example
9306
9307 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
9308 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
9309 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
9310 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
9311 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
9312 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in @LaTeX{} can be
9313 achieved using either the listings or the
9314 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. Refer to
9315 @code{org-export-latex-listings} documentation for details.}. This is done
9316 with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to specify the name of the
9317 major mode that should be used to fontify the example@footnote{Code in
9318 @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either interactively or on export.
9319 See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more information on evaluating code
9320 blocks.}, see @ref{Easy Templates} for shortcuts to easily insert code
9321 blocks.
9322 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
9323
9324 @example
9325 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
9326 (defun org-xor (a b)
9327 "Exclusive or."
9328 (if a (not b) b))
9329 #+END_SRC
9330 @end example
9331
9332 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
9333 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
9334 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
9335 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
9336 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
9337 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e., the reference name
9338 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9339 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9340 cool.
9341
9342 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9343 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9344 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9345 be useful to explain those in an Org mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9346 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9347 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9348 Here is an example:
9349
9350 @example
9351 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9352 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9353 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9354 #+END_SRC
9355 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9356 jumps to point-min.
9357 @end example
9358
9359 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9360 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9361 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9362 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9363
9364 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9365 areas in HTML export}).
9366
9367 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9368 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9369 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9370
9371 @table @kbd
9372 @kindex C-c '
9373 @item C-c '
9374 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9375 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9376 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*},
9377 @samp{,*}, @samp{#+} and @samp{,#+} will get a comma prepended, to keep them
9378 from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special syntax. These
9379 commas will be stripped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}.
9380 The edited version will then replace the old version in the Org buffer.
9381 Fixed-width regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space)
9382 will be edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select
9383 a different-mode with the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.}
9384 to allow creating ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line
9385 will create a new fixed-width region.
9386 @kindex C-c l
9387 @item C-c l
9388 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9389 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9390 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9391 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9392 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9393 @end table
9394
9395
9396 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9397 @section Include files
9398 @cindex include files, markup rules
9399
9400 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9401 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9402 @cindex #+INCLUDE
9403
9404 @example
9405 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9406 @end example
9407 @noindent
9408 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g., @samp{quote},
9409 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9410 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9411 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
9412 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9413 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9414 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9415 Org mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9416 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9417 use
9418
9419 @example
9420 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9421 @end example
9422
9423 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9424 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9425 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9426 obvious defaults.
9427
9428 @example
9429 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9430 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9431 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9432 @end example
9433
9434 @table @kbd
9435 @kindex C-c '
9436 @item C-c '
9437 Visit the include file at point.
9438 @end table
9439
9440 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9441 @section Index entries
9442 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9443
9444 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9445 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9446 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9447 an index} for more information.
9448
9449 @example
9450 * Curriculum Vitae
9451 #+INDEX: CV
9452 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9453 @end example
9454
9455
9456
9457
9458 @node Macro replacement, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Index entries, Markup
9459 @section Macro replacement
9460 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9461 @cindex #+MACRO
9462
9463 You can define text snippets with
9464
9465 @example
9466 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9467 @end example
9468
9469 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9470 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9471 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9472 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9473 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9474 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9475 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9476 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9477 @code{format-time-string}.
9478
9479 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9480 construct complex HTML code.
9481
9482
9483 @node Embedded @LaTeX{}, , Macro replacement, Markup
9484 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9485 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9486 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9487
9488 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9489 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9490 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9491 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9492 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9493 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org mode
9494 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9495 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9496 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9497
9498 @menu
9499 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9500 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9501 * @LaTeX{} fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9502 * Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9503 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9504 @end menu
9505
9506 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9507 @subsection Special symbols
9508 @cindex math symbols
9509 @cindex special symbols
9510 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9511 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9512 @cindex HTML entities
9513 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9514
9515 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9516 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9517 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9518 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9519 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9520 delimiters, for example:
9521
9522 @example
9523 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9524 @end example
9525
9526 @vindex org-entities
9527 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9528 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9529 @code{&alpha;} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9530 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and
9531 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9532 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9533
9534 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9535 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9536 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9537 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9538 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9539
9540 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9541 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9542 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9543 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9544
9545 @table @kbd
9546 @kindex C-c C-x \
9547 @item C-c C-x \
9548 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9549 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9550 for display purposes only.
9551 @end table
9552
9553 @node Subscripts and superscripts, @LaTeX{} fragments, Special symbols, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9554 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9555 @cindex subscript
9556 @cindex superscript
9557
9558 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9559 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9560 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9561 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9562 with curly braces. For example
9563
9564 @example
9565 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9566 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9567 @end example
9568
9569 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9570 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9571 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9572 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9573 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9574 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9575 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9576
9577 @example
9578 #+OPTIONS: ^:@{@}
9579 @end example
9580
9581 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9582 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9583
9584 @table @kbd
9585 @kindex C-c C-x \
9586 @item C-c C-x \
9587 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9588 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9589 @end table
9590
9591 @node @LaTeX{} fragments, Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9592 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9593 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9594
9595 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9596 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9597 needed. Org mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9598 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9599 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9600 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9601 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9602 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9603 @file{MathJax} on your own
9604 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9605 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9606 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9607 need the @file{dvipng} program or the @file{convert}, respectively available
9608 at @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/} and from the
9609 @file{imagemagick} suite. The @LaTeX{} header that will be used when
9610 processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9611 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9612 DocBook documents.
9613
9614 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9615 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9616 @itemize @bullet
9617 @item
9618 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9619 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9620 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9621 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9622 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9623 @item
9624 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9625 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9626 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9627 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9628 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9629 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9630 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9631 @end itemize
9632
9633 @noindent For example:
9634
9635 @example
9636 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9637 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9638 \end@{equation@} % etc
9639
9640 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9641 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9642 @end example
9643
9644 @noindent
9645 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9646 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9647 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9648 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9649
9650 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9651 @LaTeX{} processing can be configured with the variable
9652 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9653 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9654 @LaTeX{} backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9655 of these lines:
9656
9657 @example
9658 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9659 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9660 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9661 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9662 @end example
9663
9664 @node Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, CDLaTeX mode, @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9665 @subsection Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments
9666 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, preview
9667
9668 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9669 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9670
9671 @table @kbd
9672 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
9673 @item C-c C-x C-l
9674 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9675 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9676 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9677 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9678 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9679 process the entire buffer.
9680 @kindex C-c C-c
9681 @item C-c C-c
9682 Remove the overlay preview images.
9683 @end table
9684
9685 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9686 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9687 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9688 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9689 preview images.
9690
9691 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing @LaTeX{} fragments, Embedded @LaTeX{}
9692 @subsection Using CD@LaTeX{} to enter math
9693 @cindex CD@LaTeX{}
9694
9695 CD@LaTeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9696 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9697 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
9698 some of the features of CD@LaTeX{} mode. You need to install
9699 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9700 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9701 Don't use CD@LaTeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
9702 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
9703 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9704 Org files with
9705
9706 @lisp
9707 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9708 @end lisp
9709
9710 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9711 details see the documentation of CD@LaTeX{} mode):
9712 @itemize @bullet
9713 @kindex C-c @{
9714 @item
9715 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9716 @item
9717 @kindex @key{TAB}
9718 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9719 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9720 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9721 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9722 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9723 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9724 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9725 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9726 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9727 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9728 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9729 @item
9730 @kindex _
9731 @kindex ^
9732 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9733 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9734 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9735 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9736 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9737 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9738 @item
9739 @kindex `
9740 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9741 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9742 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9743 @item
9744 @kindex '
9745 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9746 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9747 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9748 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9749 is normal.
9750 @end itemize
9751
9752 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9753 @chapter Exporting
9754 @cindex exporting
9755
9756 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9757 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9758 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9759 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9760 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
9761 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9762 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9763 DocBook tools. OpenDocument Text (ODT) export allows seamless
9764 collaboration across organizational boundaries. For project management you
9765 can create gantt and resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To
9766 incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines or appointments into
9767 a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also produce extracts in
9768 the iCalendar format. Currently, Org mode only supports export, not import of
9769 these different formats.
9770
9771 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9772 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9773
9774 @menu
9775 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9776 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9777 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9778 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9779 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9780 * @LaTeX{} and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9781 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9782 * OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text
9783 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9784 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9785 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9786 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9787 @end menu
9788
9789 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9790 @section Selective export
9791 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9792
9793 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9794 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9795 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9796 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9797 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9798 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags},
9799 respectively defaulting to @code{'(:export:)} and @code{'(:noexport:)}.
9800
9801 @enumerate
9802 @item
9803 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9804 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9805 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9806 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9807
9808 @item
9809 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9810 export.
9811
9812 @item
9813 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9814 be removed from the export buffer.
9815 @end enumerate
9816
9817 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9818 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9819 variable for more information.
9820
9821 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9822 @section Export options
9823 @cindex options, for export
9824
9825 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9826 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9827 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9828 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9829 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9830 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9831 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9832 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9833 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9834 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9835
9836 @table @kbd
9837 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9838 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9839 @end table
9840
9841 @cindex #+TITLE
9842 @cindex #+AUTHOR
9843 @cindex #+DATE
9844 @cindex #+EMAIL
9845 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9846 @cindex #+KEYWORDS
9847 @cindex #+LANGUAGE
9848 @cindex #+TEXT
9849 @cindex #+OPTIONS
9850 @cindex #+BIND
9851 @cindex #+LINK_UP
9852 @cindex #+LINK_HOME
9853 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9854 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9855 @cindex #+XSLT
9856 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
9857 @vindex user-full-name
9858 @vindex user-mail-address
9859 @vindex org-export-default-language
9860 @vindex org-export-date-timestamp-format
9861 @example
9862 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9863 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9864 #+DATE: a date, an Org timestamp@footnote{@code{org-export-date-timestamp-format} defines how this timestamp will be exported.}, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9865 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9866 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9867 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g., for the XHTML meta tag
9868 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g., @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9869 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9870 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9871 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9872 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g., @code{org-export-latex-low-levels itemize}
9873 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9874 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9875 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9876 #+LaTeX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the @LaTeX{} header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9877 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9878 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9879 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9880 @end example
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 The @code{#+OPTIONS} line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9884 this way, you can use several @code{#+OPTIONS} lines.} form to specify export
9885 settings. Here you can:
9886 @cindex headline levels
9887 @cindex section-numbers
9888 @cindex table of contents
9889 @cindex line-break preservation
9890 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9891 @cindex fixed-width sections
9892 @cindex tables
9893 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9894 @cindex footnotes
9895 @cindex special strings
9896 @cindex emphasized text
9897 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9898 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9899 @cindex author info, in export
9900 @cindex time info, in export
9901 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9902 @vindex org-export-author-info
9903 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9904 @vindex org-export-email-info
9905 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9906 @example
9907 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9908 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9909 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9910 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9911 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9912 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9913 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9914 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9915 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9916 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9917 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9918 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9919 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9920 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9921 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9922 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9923 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9924 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9925 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9926 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9927 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9928 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9929 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9930 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9931 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9932 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9933 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers, or list drawers to include}
9934 @end example
9935 @noindent
9936 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9937 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9938 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9939
9940 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9941 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9942 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9943 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9944
9945 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9946 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9947 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9948 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9949 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9950
9951 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9952 @section The export dispatcher
9953 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9954
9955 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9956 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9957 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9958 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9959 the subtrees are exported.
9960
9961 @table @kbd
9962 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9963 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9964 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9965 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9966 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9967 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9968 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9969 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9970 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9971 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9972 (i.e., not hidden by outline visibility).
9973 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9974 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9975 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9976 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e., request background processing if
9977 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9978 @end table
9979
9980 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9981 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9982 @cindex ASCII export
9983 @cindex Latin-1 export
9984 @cindex UTF-8 export
9985
9986 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
9987 file, containing only plain ASCII@. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9988 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9989
9990 @cindex region, active
9991 @cindex active region
9992 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9993 @table @kbd
9994 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9995 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9996 Export as an ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9997 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9998 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9999 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10000 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10001 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
10002 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
10003 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
10004 export.
10005 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
10006 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10007 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
10008 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
10009 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
10010 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
10011 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
10012 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
10013 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
10014 Export only the visible part of the document.
10015 @end table
10016
10017 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10018 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10019 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10020 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
10021 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
10022
10023 @example
10024 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
10025 @end example
10026
10027 @noindent
10028 creates only top level headlines and exports the rest as items. When
10029 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
10030 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
10031 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
10032 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
10033 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
10034 indentation than the first one, these are left alone.
10035
10036 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
10037 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
10038 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
10039 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
10040
10041 @node HTML export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
10042 @section HTML export
10043 @cindex HTML export
10044
10045 Org mode contains a HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
10046 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
10047 language, but with additional support for tables.
10048
10049 @menu
10050 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
10051 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
10052 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
10053 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10054 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
10055 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
10056 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
10057 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
10058 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
10059 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
10060 @end menu
10061
10062 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
10063 @subsection HTML export commands
10064
10065 @cindex region, active
10066 @cindex active region
10067 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10068 @table @kbd
10069 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
10070 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10071 Export as a HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
10072 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
10073 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10074 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10075 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10076 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10077 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10078 property, that name will be used for the export.
10079 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
10080 Export as a HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
10081 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
10082 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10083 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
10084 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
10085 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
10086 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
10087 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
10088 Export only the visible part of the document.
10089 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
10090 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10091 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10092 buffer.
10093 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
10094 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
10095 code.
10096 @end table
10097
10098 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10099 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
10100 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
10101 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
10102 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10103
10104 @example
10105 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
10106 @end example
10107
10108 @noindent
10109 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10110
10111
10112 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
10113 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
10114 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10115 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10116 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
10117 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
10118 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
10119 @vindex org-export-author-info
10120 @vindex org-export-email-info
10121 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10122 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
10123
10124 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
10125
10126 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
10127 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant format string
10128 in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
10129
10130 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
10131 format string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
10132 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
10133 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
10134 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
10135 insert any preamble.
10136
10137 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
10138 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
10139 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
10140 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
10141 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
10142 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
10143 postamble from the relevant format string found in
10144 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
10145 insert any postamble.
10146
10147 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
10148 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
10149
10150 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
10151 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
10152 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
10153 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
10154 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
10155 the exported file use either
10156
10157 @cindex #+HTML
10158 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10159 @example
10160 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
10161 @end example
10162
10163 @noindent or
10164 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
10165
10166 @example
10167 #+BEGIN_HTML
10168 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10169 #+END_HTML
10170 @end example
10171
10172
10173 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
10174 @subsection Links in HTML export
10175
10176 @cindex links, in HTML export
10177 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
10178 @cindex external links, in HTML export
10179 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML@. This
10180 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
10181 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
10182 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
10183 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
10184 that a HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
10185 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
10186 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
10187 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
10188
10189 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
10190 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
10191 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
10192 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
10193
10194 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10195 @example
10196 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org mode homepage" style="color:red;"
10197 [[http://orgmode.org]]
10198 @end example
10199
10200 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
10201 @subsection Tables
10202 @cindex tables, in HTML
10203 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10204
10205 Org mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
10206 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
10207 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
10208 tables, place something like the following before the table:
10209
10210 @cindex #+CAPTION
10211 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10212 @example
10213 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
10214 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="border"
10215 @end example
10216
10217 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
10218 @subsection Images in HTML export
10219
10220 @cindex images, inline in HTML
10221 @cindex inlining images in HTML
10222 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10223 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
10224 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
10225 default@footnote{But see the variable
10226 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
10227 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
10228 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
10229 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
10230 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
10231 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
10232 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
10233 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
10234
10235 @example
10236 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
10237 @end example
10238
10239 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
10240 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
10241 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
10242
10243 @cindex #+CAPTION
10244 @cindex #+ATTR_HTML
10245 @example
10246 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
10247 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
10248 [[./img/a.jpg]]
10249 @end example
10250
10251 @noindent
10252 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
10253
10254 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
10255 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
10256 @cindex MathJax
10257 @cindex dvipng
10258
10259 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be displayed in two
10260 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
10261 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
10262 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
10263 @file{MathJax} for Org mode users for small applications and for testing
10264 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
10265 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
10266 found on the MathJax website, see
10267 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
10268 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
10269 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
10270 insert something like the following into the buffer:
10271
10272 @example
10273 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
10274 @end example
10275
10276 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
10277 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
10278 this line.
10279
10280 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
10281 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
10282 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
10283 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
10284 You can still get this processing with
10285
10286 @example
10287 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
10288 @end example
10289
10290 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
10291 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
10292
10293 @cindex text areas, in HTML
10294 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
10295 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
10296 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
10297 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
10298 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
10299 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
10300 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
10301 respectively. For example
10302
10303 @example
10304 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
10305 (defun org-xor (a b)
10306 "Exclusive or."
10307 (if a (not b) b))
10308 #+END_EXAMPLE
10309 @end example
10310
10311
10312 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
10313 @subsection CSS support
10314 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
10315 @cindex HTML export, CSS
10316
10317 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
10318 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
10319 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
10320 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
10321 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
10322 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
10323 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
10324 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
10325 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
10326 @example
10327 p.author @r{author information, including email}
10328 p.date @r{publishing date}
10329 p.creator @r{creator info, about org mode version}
10330 .title @r{document title}
10331 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
10332 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
10333 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
10334 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
10335 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
10336 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
10337 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
10338 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
10339 .target @r{target for links}
10340 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10341 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10342 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10343 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10344 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10345 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10346 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10347 pre.example @r{normal example}
10348 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10349 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10350 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10351 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10352 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10353 @end example
10354
10355 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10356 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10357 @vindex org-export-html-style
10358 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10359 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10360 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10361 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10362 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10363 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10364 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10365 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10366 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10367 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10368 individually for each file, you can use
10369
10370 @cindex #+STYLE
10371 @example
10372 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10373 @end example
10374
10375 @noindent
10376 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10377 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10378 referring to an external file.
10379
10380 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10381 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10382 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10383 property.
10384
10385 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10386 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10387
10388 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10389 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10390
10391 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10392 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10393 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10394 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10395 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10396 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10397 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10398 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10399 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10400 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10401 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10402 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10403 copy on your own web server.
10404
10405 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10406 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10407 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10408 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10409 adding a single line to the Org file:
10410
10411 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10412 @example
10413 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10414 @end example
10415
10416 @noindent
10417 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10418 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10419 viewing options:
10420
10421 @example
10422 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10423 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10424 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10425 view: @r{Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10426 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10427 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10428 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10429 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10430 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10431 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10432 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10433 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10434 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10435 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10436 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10437 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10438 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10439 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10440 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10441 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10442 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10443 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10444 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10445 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10446 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10447 @end example
10448 @noindent
10449 @vindex org-infojs-options
10450 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10451 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10452 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10453 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10454
10455 @node @LaTeX{} and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10456 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10457 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10458 @cindex PDF export
10459 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10460
10461 Org mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10462 further processing@footnote{The default @LaTeX{} output is designed for
10463 processing with @code{pdftex} or @LaTeX{}. It includes packages that are not
10464 compatible with @code{xetex} and possibly @code{luatex}. See the variables
10465 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10466 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10467 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10468 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10469 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10470 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10471 sections.
10472
10473 @menu
10474 * @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands::
10475 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10476 * Quoting @LaTeX{} code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10477 * Tables in @LaTeX{} export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10478 * Images in @LaTeX{} export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10479 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10480 @end menu
10481
10482 @node @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10483 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10484
10485 @cindex region, active
10486 @cindex active region
10487 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10488 @table @kbd
10489 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10490 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10491 Export as a @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10492 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10493 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10494 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10495 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10496 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10497 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10498 property, that name will be used for the export.
10499 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10500 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10501 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10502 Export only the visible part of the document.
10503 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10504 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was in Org mode
10505 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10506 buffer.
10507 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10508 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10509 code.
10510 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10511 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10512 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10513 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10514 @end table
10515
10516 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10517 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10518 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10519 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10520 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10521 convert them to a custom string depending on
10522 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10523
10524 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10525 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10526
10527 @example
10528 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10529 @end example
10530
10531 @noindent
10532 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10533
10534 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{}/PDF export commands, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10535 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10536 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10537 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10538 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10539 @cindex header, for @LaTeX{} files
10540 @cindex sectioning structure, for @LaTeX{} export
10541
10542 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10543
10544 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10545 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10546 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10547 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10548 @cindex #+LaTeX_HEADER
10549 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS
10550 @cindex #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10551 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS
10552 @cindex property, LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10553 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10554 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10555 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10556 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10557 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10558 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10559 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10560 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10561 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10562 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS:}
10563 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. The
10564 options to documentclass have to be provided, as expected by @LaTeX{}, within
10565 square brackets. You can also use @code{#+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}}
10566 to add lines to the header. See the docstring of
10567 @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more information. An example is shown
10568 below.
10569
10570 @example
10571 #+LaTeX_CLASS: article
10572 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper]
10573 #+LaTeX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}
10574
10575 * Headline 1
10576 some text
10577 @end example
10578
10579 @node Quoting @LaTeX{} code, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Header and sectioning, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10580 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10581
10582 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded @LaTeX{}}, will be correctly
10583 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10584 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10585 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10586 the following constructs:
10587
10588 @cindex #+LaTeX
10589 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10590 @example
10591 #+LaTeX: Literal @LaTeX{} code for export
10592 @end example
10593
10594 @noindent or
10595 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10596
10597 @example
10598 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10599 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10600 #+END_LaTeX
10601 @end example
10602
10603
10604 @node Tables in @LaTeX{} export, Images in @LaTeX{} export, Quoting @LaTeX{} code, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10605 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10606 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10607
10608 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10609 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10610 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10611 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10612 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10613 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10614 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10615 width:
10616
10617 @cindex #+CAPTION
10618 @cindex #+LABEL
10619 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10620 @example
10621 #+CAPTION: A long table
10622 #+LABEL: tbl:long
10623 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10624 | ..... | ..... |
10625 | ..... | ..... |
10626 @end example
10627
10628 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10629
10630 @cindex #+CAPTION
10631 @cindex #+LABEL
10632 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10633 @example
10634 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10635 #+LABEL: tbl:wide
10636 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10637 | ..... | ..... |
10638 | ..... | ..... |
10639 @end example
10640
10641 @node Images in @LaTeX{} export, Beamer class export, Tables in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10642 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10643 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10644 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10645
10646 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10647 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10648 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10649 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10650 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10651 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10652 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10653 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10654 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10655 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10656 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10657 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10658 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10659 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10660 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10661 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}.
10662
10663 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10664 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10665 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10666 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10667 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10668 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10669
10670 @cindex #+CAPTION
10671 @cindex #+LABEL
10672 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10673 @example
10674 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10675 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10676 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10677 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10678
10679 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10680 [[./img/hst.png]]
10681 @end example
10682
10683 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10684 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10685 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10686
10687 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10688 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10689
10690 @node Beamer class export, , Images in @LaTeX{} export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10691 @subsection Beamer class export
10692
10693 The @LaTeX{} class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10694 using @LaTeX{} and pdf processing. Org mode has special support for turning an
10695 Org mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10696
10697 When the @LaTeX{} class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10698 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10699 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10700 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10701 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10702 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10703 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10704 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10705 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10706 structure of the presentation.
10707
10708 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10709 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10710 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10711 editing special properties used by beamer.
10712
10713 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10714 properties:
10715
10716 @table @code
10717 @item BEAMER_env
10718 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10719 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10720 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10721 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10722 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10723 @item BEAMER_envargs
10724 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10725 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10726 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10727 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10728 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10729 environment.
10730 @item BEAMER_col
10731 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10732 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10733 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10734 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10735 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10736 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10737 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10738 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10739 @item BEAMER_extra
10740 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10741 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10742 transitions.
10743 @end table
10744
10745 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10746 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10747 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10748 @code{#+BEGIN_BEAMER...#+END_BEAMER} constructs, similar to other export
10749 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10750 in the presentation as well.
10751
10752 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10753 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10754 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10755 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10756 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10757 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10758 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10759
10760 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10761 support with
10762
10763 @example
10764 #+STARTUP: beamer
10765 @end example
10766
10767 @table @kbd
10768 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10769 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10770 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10771 @end table
10772
10773 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10774 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10775 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10776 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10777
10778 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10779
10780 @smallexample
10781 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10782 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10783 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10784 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10785 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10786 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10787 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10788
10789 * This is the first structural section
10790
10791 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10792 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10793 :PROPERTIES:
10794 :BEAMER_env: block
10795 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10796 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10797 :END:
10798 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10799 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10800 :PROPERTIES:
10801 :BEAMER_col: 0.5
10802 :BEAMER_env: block
10803 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10804 :END:
10805 for contributing to the discussion
10806 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10807 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10808 *** Request :B_block:
10809 Please test this stuff!
10810 :PROPERTIES:
10811 :BEAMER_env: block
10812 :END:
10813 @end smallexample
10814
10815 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10816
10817 @node DocBook export, OpenDocument Text export, @LaTeX{} and PDF export, Exporting
10818 @section DocBook export
10819 @cindex DocBook export
10820 @cindex PDF export
10821 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10822
10823 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10824 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10825 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10826 tools and stylesheets.
10827
10828 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10829
10830 @menu
10831 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10832 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10833 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10834 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10835 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10836 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10837 @end menu
10838
10839 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10840 @subsection DocBook export commands
10841
10842 @cindex region, active
10843 @cindex active region
10844 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10845 @table @kbd
10846 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10847 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10848 Export as a DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10849 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10850 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10851 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10852 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10853 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10854 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10855 property, that name will be used for the export.
10856 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10857 Export as a DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10858
10859 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10860 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10861 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on an exported DocBook file,
10862 you need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10863 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10864 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10865
10866 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10867 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10868 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10869 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10870 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10871 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10872
10873 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10874 Export only the visible part of the document.
10875 @end table
10876
10877 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10878 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10879
10880 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10881 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10882
10883 @cindex #+DOCBOOK
10884 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10885 @example
10886 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10887 @end example
10888
10889 @noindent or
10890 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10891
10892 @example
10893 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10894 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10895 literally.
10896 #+END_DOCBOOK
10897 @end example
10898
10899 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10900 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10901 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10902 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10903
10904 @example
10905 #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10906 <warning>
10907 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10908 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10909 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10910 </warning>
10911 #+END_DOCBOOK
10912 @end example
10913
10914 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10915 @subsection Recursive sections
10916 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10917
10918 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10919 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e., @code{section} elements, are
10920 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10921 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10922 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10923 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10924
10925 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10926 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10927
10928 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10929 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10930 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10931
10932 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10933 DocBook V4.3.
10934
10935 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10936 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10937 using the @code{table} element.
10938
10939 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10940 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10941 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10942 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10943
10944 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10945 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10946 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10947 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10948 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10949 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10950 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10951 @code{mediaobject} element.
10952
10953 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10954 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10955 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10956 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10957 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10958 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10959 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10960 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10961
10962 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10963 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10964 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10965 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10966 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10967 set:
10968
10969 @cindex #+CAPTION
10970 @cindex #+LABEL
10971 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10972 @example
10973 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
10974 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10975 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10976 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10977 @end example
10978
10979 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10980 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10981 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10982 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10983 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10984
10985 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10986 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10987 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10988
10989 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10990 @vindex org-entities
10991 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10992 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10993 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{&alpha;},
10994 @code{&Gamma;}, and @code{&Zeta;}, based on the list saved in variable
10995 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10996 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10997
10998 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10999 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
11000 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
11001 special characters included in XHTML entities:
11002
11003 @example
11004 "<!DOCTYPE article [
11005 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
11006 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
11007 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
11008 >
11009 %xhtml1-symbol;
11010 ]>
11011 "
11012 @end example
11013
11014 @c begin opendocument
11015
11016 @node OpenDocument Text export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
11017 @section OpenDocument Text export
11018 @cindex K, Jambunathan
11019 @cindex ODT
11020 @cindex OpenDocument
11021 @cindex export, OpenDocument
11022 @cindex LibreOffice
11023 @cindex org-odt.el
11024 @cindex org-modules
11025
11026 Org Mode@footnote{Versions 7.8 or later} supports export to OpenDocument Text
11027 (ODT) format using the @file{org-odt.el} module. Documents created
11028 by this exporter use the @cite{OpenDocument-v1.2
11029 specification}@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11030 Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) Version 1.2}} and
11031 are compatible with LibreOffice 3.4.
11032
11033 @menu
11034 * Pre-requisites for ODT export:: What packages ODT exporter relies on
11035 * ODT export commands:: How to invoke ODT export
11036 * Extending ODT export:: How to produce @samp{doc}, @samp{pdf} files
11037 * Applying custom styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
11038 * Links in ODT export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
11039 * Tables in ODT export:: How Tables are exported
11040 * Images in ODT export:: How to insert images
11041 * Math formatting in ODT export:: How @LaTeX{} fragments are formatted
11042 * Labels and captions in ODT export:: How captions are rendered
11043 * Literal examples in ODT export:: How source and example blocks are formatted
11044 * Advanced topics in ODT export:: Read this if you are a power user
11045 @end menu
11046
11047 @node Pre-requisites for ODT export, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export, OpenDocument Text export
11048 @subsection Pre-requisites for ODT export
11049 @cindex zip
11050 The ODT exporter relies on the @file{zip} program to create the final
11051 output. Check the availability of this program before proceeding further.
11052
11053 @node ODT export commands, Extending ODT export, Pre-requisites for ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11054 @subsection ODT export commands
11055
11056 @subsubheading Exporting to ODT
11057 @anchor{x-export-to-odt}
11058
11059 @cindex region, active
11060 @cindex active region
11061 @cindex transient-mark-mode
11062 @table @kbd
11063 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
11064 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
11065
11066 Export as OpenDocument Text file.
11067
11068 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11069 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, automatically
11070 convert the exported file to that format. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, ,
11071 Automatically exporting to other formats}.
11072
11073 For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the ODT file will be
11074 @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be overwritten without warning. If there
11075 is an active region,@footnote{This requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be
11076 turned on} only the region will be exported. If the selected region is a
11077 single tree,@footnote{To select the current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}} the
11078 tree head will become the document title. If the tree head entry has, or
11079 inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
11080 export.
11081
11082 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
11083 Export as an OpenDocument Text file and open the resulting file.
11084
11085 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11086 If @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format} is specified, open the
11087 converted file instead. @xref{x-export-to-other-formats, , Automatically
11088 exporting to other formats}.
11089 @end table
11090
11091 @node Extending ODT export, Applying custom styles, ODT export commands, OpenDocument Text export
11092 @subsection Extending ODT export
11093
11094 The ODT exporter can interface with a variety of document
11095 converters and supports popular converters out of the box. As a result, you
11096 can use it to export to formats like @samp{doc} or convert a document from
11097 one format (say @samp{csv}) to another format (say @samp{ods} or @samp{xls}).
11098
11099 @cindex @file{unoconv}
11100 @cindex LibreOffice
11101 If you have a working installation of LibreOffice, a document converter is
11102 pre-configured for you and you can use it right away. If you would like to
11103 use @file{unoconv} as your preferred converter, customize the variable
11104 @code{org-export-odt-convert-process} to point to @code{unoconv}. You can
11105 also use your own favorite converter or tweak the default settings of the
11106 @file{LibreOffice} and @samp{unoconv} converters. @xref{Configuring a
11107 document converter}.
11108
11109 @subsubsection Automatically exporting to other formats
11110 @anchor{x-export-to-other-formats}
11111
11112 @vindex org-export-odt-preferred-output-format
11113 Very often, you will find yourself exporting to ODT format, only to
11114 immediately save the exported document to other formats like @samp{doc},
11115 @samp{docx}, @samp{rtf}, @samp{pdf} etc. In such cases, you can specify your
11116 preferred output format by customizing the variable
11117 @code{org-export-odt-preferred-output-format}. This way, the export commands
11118 (@pxref{x-export-to-odt,,Exporting to ODT}) can be extended to export to a
11119 format that is of immediate interest to you.
11120
11121 @subsubsection Converting between document formats
11122 @anchor{x-convert-to-other-formats}
11123
11124 There are many document converters in the wild which support conversion to
11125 and from various file formats, including, but not limited to the
11126 ODT format. LibreOffice converter, mentioned above, is one such
11127 converter. Once a converter is configured, you can interact with it using
11128 the following command.
11129
11130 @vindex org-export-odt-convert
11131 @table @kbd
11132
11133 @item M-x org-export-odt-convert
11134 Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a prefix
11135 argument, also open the newly produced file.
11136 @end table
11137
11138 @node Applying custom styles, Links in ODT export, Extending ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11139 @subsection Applying custom styles
11140 @cindex styles, custom
11141 @cindex template, custom
11142
11143 The ODT exporter ships with a set of OpenDocument styles
11144 (@pxref{Working with OpenDocument style files}) that ensure a well-formatted
11145 output. These factory styles, however, may not cater to your specific
11146 tastes. To customize the output, you can either modify the above styles
11147 files directly, or generate the required styles using an application like
11148 LibreOffice. The latter method is suitable for expert and non-expert
11149 users alike, and is described here.
11150
11151 @subsubsection Applying custom styles: the easy way
11152
11153 @enumerate
11154 @item
11155 Create a sample @file{example.org} file with the below settings and export it
11156 to ODT format.
11157
11158 @example
11159 #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t
11160 @end example
11161
11162 @item
11163 Open the above @file{example.odt} using LibreOffice. Use the @file{Stylist}
11164 to locate the target styles---these typically have the @samp{Org} prefix---and
11165 modify those to your taste. Save the modified file either as an
11166 OpenDocument Text (@file{.odt}) or OpenDocument Template (@file{.ott}) file.
11167
11168 @item
11169 @cindex #+ODT_STYLES_FILE
11170 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
11171 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} and point it to the
11172 newly created file. For additional configuration options
11173 @pxref{x-overriding-factory-styles,,Overriding factory styles}.
11174
11175 If you would like to choose a style on a per-file basis, you can use the
11176 @code{#+ODT_STYLES_FILE} option. A typical setting will look like
11177
11178 @example
11179 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott"
11180 @end example
11181
11182 or
11183
11184 @example
11185 #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png"))
11186 @end example
11187
11188 @end enumerate
11189
11190 @subsubsection Using third-party styles and templates
11191
11192 You can use third-party styles and templates for customizing your output.
11193 This will produce the desired output only if the template provides all
11194 style names that the @samp{ODT} exporter relies on. Unless this condition is
11195 met, the output is going to be less than satisfactory. So it is highly
11196 recommended that you only work with templates that are directly derived from
11197 the factory settings.
11198
11199 @node Links in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, Applying custom styles, OpenDocument Text export
11200 @subsection Links in ODT export
11201 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11202
11203 ODT exporter creates native cross-references for internal links. It creates
11204 Internet-style links for all other links.
11205
11206 A link with no description and destined to a regular (un-itemized) outline
11207 heading is replaced with a cross-reference and section number of the heading.
11208
11209 A @samp{\ref@{label@}}-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced
11210 with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity.
11211 @xref{Labels and captions in ODT export}.
11212
11213 @node Tables in ODT export, Images in ODT export, Links in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11214 @subsection Tables in ODT export
11215 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
11216
11217 Export of native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and simple @file{table.el}
11218 tables is supported. However, export of complex @file{table.el} tables---tables
11219 that have column or row spans---is not supported. Such tables are
11220 stripped from the exported document.
11221
11222 By default, a table is exported with top and bottom frames and with rules
11223 separating row and column groups (@pxref{Column groups}). Furthermore, all
11224 tables are typeset to occupy the same width. If the table specifies
11225 alignment and relative width for its columns (@pxref{Column width and
11226 alignment}) then these are honored on export.@footnote{The column widths are
11227 interpreted as weighted ratios with the default weight being 1}
11228
11229 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11230 You can control the width of the table by specifying @code{:rel-width}
11231 property using an @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line.
11232
11233 For example, consider the following table which makes use of all the rules
11234 mentioned above.
11235
11236 @example
11237 #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50
11238 | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum |
11239 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11240 | / | < | | | < |
11241 | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> |
11242 | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 |
11243 | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 |
11244 | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 |
11245 |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------|
11246 | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 |
11247 @end example
11248
11249 On export, the table will occupy 50% of text area. The columns will be sized
11250 (roughly) in the ratio of 13:5:5:5:6. The first column will be left-aligned
11251 and rest of the columns will be right-aligned. There will be vertical rules
11252 after separating the header and last columns from other columns. There will
11253 be horizontal rules separating the header and last rows from other rows.
11254
11255 If you are not satisfied with the above formatting options, you can create
11256 custom table styles and associate them with a table using the
11257 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. @xref{Customizing tables in ODT export}.
11258
11259 @node Images in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, Tables in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11260 @subsection Images in ODT export
11261 @cindex images, embedding in ODT
11262 @cindex embedding images in ODT
11263
11264 @subsubheading Embedding images
11265 You can embed images within the exported document by providing a link to the
11266 desired image file with no link description. For example, to embed
11267 @samp{img.png} do either of the following:
11268
11269 @example
11270 [[file:img.png]]
11271 @end example
11272
11273 @example
11274 [[./img.png]]
11275 @end example
11276
11277 @subsubheading Embedding clickable images
11278 You can create clickable images by providing a link whose description is a
11279 link to an image file. For example, to embed a image
11280 @file{org-mode-unicorn.png} which when clicked jumps to
11281 @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website, do the following
11282
11283 @example
11284 [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]]
11285 @end example
11286
11287 @subsubheading Sizing and scaling of embedded images
11288
11289 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11290 You can control the size and scale of the embedded images using the
11291 @code{#+ATTR_ODT} attribute.
11292
11293 @cindex identify, ImageMagick
11294 @vindex org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch
11295 The exporter specifies the desired size of the image in the final document in
11296 units of centimeters. In order to scale the embedded images, the exporter
11297 queries for pixel dimensions of the images using one of a) ImageMagick's
11298 @file{identify} program or b) Emacs `create-image' and `image-size'
11299 APIs.@footnote{Use of @file{ImageMagick} is only desirable. However, if you
11300 routinely produce documents that have large images or you export your Org
11301 files that has images using a Emacs batch script, then the use of
11302 @file{ImageMagick} is mandatory.} The pixel dimensions are subsequently
11303 converted in to units of centimeters using
11304 @code{org-export-odt-pixels-per-inch}. The default value of this variable is
11305 set to @code{display-pixels-per-inch}. You can tweak this variable to
11306 achieve the best results.
11307
11308 The examples below illustrate the various possibilities.
11309
11310 @table @asis
11311 @item Explicitly size the image
11312 To embed @file{img.png} as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following:
11313
11314 @example
11315 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10
11316 [[./img.png]]
11317 @end example
11318
11319 @item Scale the image
11320 To embed @file{img.png} at half its size, do the following:
11321
11322 @example
11323 #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5
11324 [[./img.png]]
11325 @end example
11326
11327 @item Scale the image to a specific width
11328 To embed @file{img.png} with a width of 10 cm while retaining the original
11329 height:width ratio, do the following:
11330
11331 @example
11332 #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10
11333 [[./img.png]]
11334 @end example
11335
11336 @item Scale the image to a specific height
11337 To embed @file{img.png} with a height of 10 cm while retaining the original
11338 height:width ratio, do the following
11339
11340 @example
11341 #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10
11342 [[./img.png]]
11343 @end example
11344 @end table
11345
11346 @subsubheading Anchoring of images
11347
11348 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11349 You can control the manner in which an image is anchored by setting the
11350 @code{:anchor} property of it's @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. You can specify one
11351 of the the following three values for the @code{:anchor} property:
11352 @samp{"as-char"}, @samp{"paragraph"} and @samp{"page"}.
11353
11354 To create an image that is anchored to a page, do the following:
11355 @example
11356 #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page"
11357 [[./img.png]]
11358 @end example
11359
11360 @node Math formatting in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, Images in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11361 @subsection Math formatting in ODT export
11362
11363 The ODT exporter has special support for handling math.
11364
11365 @menu
11366 * Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets:: How to embed @LaTeX{} math fragments
11367 * Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: How to embed equations in native format
11368 @end menu
11369
11370 @node Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Math formatting in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export
11371 @subsubsection Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets
11372
11373 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{@LaTeX{} fragments}) can be embedded in the ODT
11374 document in one of the following ways:
11375
11376 @cindex MathML
11377 @enumerate
11378 @item MathML
11379
11380 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11381
11382 @example
11383 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t
11384 @end example
11385
11386 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are first converted into MathML
11387 fragments using an external @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter program. The
11388 resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument Formula in
11389 the exported document.
11390
11391 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11392 @vindex org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11393
11394 You can specify the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter by customizing the variables
11395 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command} and
11396 @code{org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file}.
11397
11398 If you prefer to use @file{MathToWeb}@footnote{See
11399 @uref{http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl, MathToWeb}} as your
11400 converter, you can configure the above variables as shown below.
11401
11402 @lisp
11403 (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command
11404 "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I"
11405 org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file
11406 "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar")
11407 @end lisp
11408
11409 You can use the following commands to quickly verify the reliability of
11410 the @LaTeX{}-to-MathML converter.
11411
11412 @table @kbd
11413
11414 @item M-x org-export-as-odf
11415 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file.
11416
11417 @item M-x org-export-as-odf-and-open
11418 Convert a @LaTeX{} math snippet to an OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file
11419 and open the formula file with the system-registered application.
11420 @end table
11421
11422 @cindex dvipng
11423 @item PNG images
11424
11425 This option is activated on a per-file basis with
11426
11427 @example
11428 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
11429 @end example
11430
11431 With this option, @LaTeX{} fragments are processed into PNG images and the
11432 resulting images are embedded in the exported document. This method requires
11433 that the @file{dvipng} program be available on your system.
11434 @end enumerate
11435
11436 @node Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, , Working with @LaTeX{} math snippets, Math formatting in ODT export
11437 @subsubsection Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files
11438
11439 For various reasons, you may find embedding @LaTeX{} math snippets in an
11440 ODT document less than reliable. In that case, you can embed a
11441 math equation by linking to its MathML (@file{.mml}) source or its
11442 OpenDocument formula (@file{.odf}) file as shown below:
11443
11444 @example
11445 [[./equation.mml]]
11446 @end example
11447
11448 or
11449
11450 @example
11451 [[./equation.odf]]
11452 @end example
11453
11454 @node Labels and captions in ODT export, Literal examples in ODT export, Math formatting in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11455 @subsection Labels and captions in ODT export
11456
11457 You can label and caption various category of objects---an inline image, a
11458 table, a @LaTeX{} fragment or a Math formula---using @code{#+LABEL} and
11459 @code{#+CAPTION} lines. @xref{Images and tables}. ODT exporter enumerates
11460 each labeled or captioned object of a given category separately. As a
11461 result, each such object is assigned a sequence number based on order of it's
11462 appearance in the Org file.
11463
11464 In the exported document, a user-provided caption is augmented with the
11465 category and sequence number. Consider the following inline image in an Org
11466 file.
11467
11468 @example
11469 #+CAPTION: Bell curve
11470 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
11471 [[./img/a.png]]
11472 @end example
11473
11474 It could be rendered as shown below in the exported document.
11475
11476 @example
11477 Figure 2: Bell curve
11478 @end example
11479
11480 @vindex org-export-odt-category-strings
11481 You can modify the category component of the caption by customizing the
11482 variable @code{org-export-odt-category-strings}. For example, to tag all
11483 embedded images with the string @samp{Illustration} (instead of the default
11484 @samp{Figure}) use the following setting.
11485
11486 @lisp
11487 (setq org-export-odt-category-strings
11488 '(("en" "Table" "Illustration" "Equation" "Equation")))
11489 @end lisp
11490
11491 With this, previous image will be captioned as below in the exported
11492 document.
11493
11494 @example
11495 Illustration 2: Bell curve
11496 @end example
11497
11498 @node Literal examples in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export, Labels and captions in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11499 @subsection Literal examples in ODT export
11500
11501 Export of literal examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) with full fontification
11502 is supported. Internally, the exporter relies on @file{htmlfontify.el} to
11503 generate all style definitions needed for a fancy listing.@footnote{Your
11504 @file{htmlfontify.el} library must at least be at Emacs 24.1 levels for
11505 fontification to be turned on.} The auto-generated styles have @samp{OrgSrc}
11506 as prefix and inherit their color from the faces used by Emacs
11507 @code{font-lock} library for the source language.
11508
11509 @vindex org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks
11510 If you prefer to use your own custom styles for fontification, you can do so
11511 by customizing the variable
11512 @code{org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks}.
11513
11514 @vindex org-export-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks
11515 You can turn off fontification of literal examples by customizing the
11516 variable @code{org-export-odt-fontify-srcblocks}.
11517
11518 @node Advanced topics in ODT export, , Literal examples in ODT export, OpenDocument Text export
11519 @subsection Advanced topics in ODT export
11520
11521 If you rely heavily on ODT export, you may want to exploit the full
11522 set of features that the exporter offers. This section describes features
11523 that would be of interest to power users.
11524
11525 @menu
11526 * Configuring a document converter:: How to register a document converter
11527 * Working with OpenDocument style files:: Explore the internals
11528 * Creating one-off styles:: How to produce custom highlighting etc
11529 * Customizing tables in ODT export:: How to define and use Table templates
11530 * Validating OpenDocument XML:: How to debug corrupt OpenDocument files
11531 @end menu
11532
11533 @node Configuring a document converter, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11534 @subsubsection Configuring a document converter
11535 @cindex convert
11536 @cindex doc, docx, rtf
11537 @cindex converter
11538
11539 The ODT exporter can work with popular converters with little or no
11540 extra configuration from your side. @xref{Extending ODT export}.
11541 If you are using a converter that is not supported by default or if you would
11542 like to tweak the default converter settings, proceed as below.
11543
11544 @enumerate
11545 @item Register the converter
11546
11547 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-processes
11548 Name your converter and add it to the list of known converters by customizing
11549 the variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-processes}. Also specify how the
11550 converter can be invoked via command-line to effect the conversion.
11551
11552 @item Configure its capabilities
11553
11554 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-capabilities
11555 @anchor{x-odt-converter-capabilities}
11556 Specify the set of formats the converter can handle by customizing the
11557 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-capabilities}. Use the default value
11558 for this variable as a guide for configuring your converter. As suggested by
11559 the default setting, you can specify the full set of formats supported by the
11560 converter and not limit yourself to specifying formats that are related to
11561 just the OpenDocument Text format.
11562
11563 @item Choose the converter
11564
11565 @vindex org-export-odt-convert-process
11566 Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by customizing the
11567 variable @code{org-export-odt-convert-process}.
11568 @end enumerate
11569
11570 @node Working with OpenDocument style files, Creating one-off styles, Configuring a document converter, Advanced topics in ODT export
11571 @subsubsection Working with OpenDocument style files
11572 @cindex styles, custom
11573 @cindex template, custom
11574
11575 This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter and the
11576 means by which it produces styled documents. Read this section if you are
11577 interested in exploring the automatic and custom OpenDocument styles used by
11578 the exporter.
11579
11580 @anchor{x-factory-styles}
11581 @subsubheading Factory styles
11582
11583 The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output.
11584 These files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to
11585 by the variable @code{org-odt-styles-dir}. The two files are:
11586
11587 @itemize
11588 @anchor{x-orgodtstyles-xml}
11589 @item
11590 @file{OrgOdtStyles.xml}
11591
11592 This file contributes to the @file{styles.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11593 document. This file gets modified for the following purposes:
11594 @enumerate
11595
11596 @item
11597 To control outline numbering based on user settings.
11598
11599 @item
11600 To add styles generated by @file{htmlfontify.el} for fontification of code
11601 blocks.
11602 @end enumerate
11603
11604 @anchor{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml}
11605 @item
11606 @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11607
11608 This file contributes to the @file{content.xml} file of the final @samp{ODT}
11609 document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the
11610 @samp{<office:text>}@dots{}@samp{</office:text>} elements of this file.
11611
11612 Apart from serving as a template file for the final @file{content.xml}, the
11613 file serves the following purposes:
11614 @enumerate
11615
11616 @item
11617 It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which are referenced by
11618 the exporter.
11619
11620 @item
11621 It contains @samp{<text:sequence-decl>}@dots{}@samp{</text:sequence-decl>}
11622 elements that control how various entities---tables, images, equations,
11623 etc.---are numbered.
11624 @end enumerate
11625 @end itemize
11626
11627 @anchor{x-overriding-factory-styles}
11628 @subsubheading Overriding factory styles
11629 The following two variables control the location from which the ODT
11630 exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. You can
11631 customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the
11632 exporter.
11633
11634 @itemize
11635 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-styles-file}
11636 @item
11637 @code{org-export-odt-styles-file}
11638
11639 Use this variable to specify the @file{styles.xml} that will be used in the
11640 final output. You can specify one of the following values:
11641
11642 @enumerate
11643 @item A @file{styles.xml} file
11644
11645 Use this file instead of the default @file{styles.xml}
11646
11647 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file
11648
11649 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11650 Template file
11651
11652 @item A @file{.odt} or @file{.ott} file and a subset of files contained within them
11653
11654 Use the @file{styles.xml} contained in the specified OpenDocument Text or
11655 Template file. Additionally extract the specified member files and embed
11656 those within the final @samp{ODT} document.
11657
11658 Use this option if the @file{styles.xml} file references additional files
11659 like header and footer images.
11660
11661 @item @code{nil}
11662
11663 Use the default @file{styles.xml}
11664 @end enumerate
11665
11666 @anchor{x-org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11667 @item
11668 @code{org-export-odt-content-template-file}
11669
11670 Use this variable to specify the blank @file{content.xml} that will be used
11671 in the final output.
11672 @end itemize
11673
11674 @node Creating one-off styles, Customizing tables in ODT export, Working with OpenDocument style files, Advanced topics in ODT export
11675 @subsubsection Creating one-off styles
11676
11677 There are times when you would want one-off formatting in the exported
11678 document. You can achieve this by embedding raw OpenDocument XML in the Org
11679 file. The use of this feature is better illustrated with couple of examples.
11680
11681 @enumerate
11682 @item Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text
11683
11684 You can include simple OpenDocument tags by prefixing them with
11685 @samp{@@}. For example, to highlight a region of text do the following:
11686
11687 @example
11688 @@<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is a
11689 highlighted text@@</text:span>. But this is a
11690 regular text.
11691 @end example
11692
11693 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11694 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11695 custom @samp{Highlight} style as shown below.
11696
11697 @example
11698 <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text">
11699 <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/>
11700 </style:style>
11701 @end example
11702
11703 @item Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML
11704
11705 You can add a simple OpenDocument one-liner using the @code{#+ODT:}
11706 directive. For example, to force a page break do the following:
11707
11708 @example
11709 #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/>
11710 @end example
11711
11712 @strong{Hint:} To see the above example in action, edit your
11713 @file{styles.xml} (@pxref{x-orgodtstyles-xml,,Factory styles}) and add a
11714 custom @samp{PageBreak} style as shown below.
11715
11716 @example
11717 <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph"
11718 style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body">
11719 <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/>
11720 </style:style>
11721 @end example
11722
11723 @item Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML
11724
11725 You can add a large block of OpenDocument XML using the
11726 @code{#+BEGIN_ODT}@dots{}@code{#+END_ODT} construct.
11727
11728 For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do the
11729 following:
11730
11731 @example
11732 #+BEGIN_ODT
11733 <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold">
11734 This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text.
11735 </text:p>
11736 #+END_ODT
11737 @end example
11738
11739 @end enumerate
11740
11741 @node Customizing tables in ODT export, Validating OpenDocument XML, Creating one-off styles, Advanced topics in ODT export
11742 @subsubsection Customizing tables in ODT export
11743 @cindex tables, in ODT export
11744
11745 @cindex #+ATTR_ODT
11746 You can override the default formatting of the table by specifying a custom
11747 table style with the @code{#+ATTR_ODT} line. For a discussion on default
11748 formatting of tables @pxref{Tables in ODT export}.
11749
11750 This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in the
11751 OpenDocument-v1.2
11752 specification.@footnote{@url{http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html,
11753 OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification}}
11754
11755
11756
11757 @subsubheading Custom table styles: an illustration
11758
11759 To have a quick preview of this feature, install the below setting and export
11760 the table that follows.
11761
11762 @lisp
11763 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11764 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11765 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11766 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11767 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11768 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11769 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11770 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11771 @end lisp
11772
11773 @example
11774 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11775 | Name | Phone | Age |
11776 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11777 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11778 @end example
11779
11780 In the above example, you used a template named @samp{Custom} and installed
11781 two table styles with the names @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and
11782 @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}. (@strong{Important:} The OpenDocument
11783 styles needed for producing the above template have been pre-defined for you.
11784 These styles are available under the section marked @samp{Custom Table
11785 Template} in @file{OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml}
11786 (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory styles}). If you need
11787 additional templates you have to define these styles yourselves.
11788
11789 @subsubheading Custom table styles: the nitty-gritty
11790 To use this feature proceed as follows:
11791
11792 @enumerate
11793 @item
11794 Create a table template@footnote{See the @code{<table:table-template>}
11795 element of the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11796
11797 A table template is nothing but a set of @samp{table-cell} and
11798 @samp{paragraph} styles for each of the following table cell categories:
11799
11800 @itemize @minus
11801 @item Body
11802 @item First column
11803 @item Last column
11804 @item First row
11805 @item Last row
11806 @item Even row
11807 @item Odd row
11808 @item Even column
11809 @item Odd Column
11810 @end itemize
11811
11812 The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of the table
11813 template using a well-defined convention.
11814
11815 The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For a table
11816 template with the name @samp{Custom}, the needed style names are listed in
11817 the following table.
11818
11819 @multitable {Table cell type} {CustomEvenColumnTableCell} {CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11820 @headitem Table cell type
11821 @tab @code{table-cell} style
11822 @tab @code{paragraph} style
11823 @item
11824 @tab
11825 @tab
11826 @item Body
11827 @tab @samp{CustomTableCell}
11828 @tab @samp{CustomTableParagraph}
11829 @item First column
11830 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableCell}
11831 @tab @samp{CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph}
11832 @item Last column
11833 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableCell}
11834 @tab @samp{CustomLastColumnTableParagraph}
11835 @item First row
11836 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableCell}
11837 @tab @samp{CustomFirstRowTableParagraph}
11838 @item Last row
11839 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableCell}
11840 @tab @samp{CustomLastRowTableParagraph}
11841 @item Even row
11842 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableCell}
11843 @tab @samp{CustomEvenRowTableParagraph}
11844 @item Odd row
11845 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableCell}
11846 @tab @samp{CustomOddRowTableParagraph}
11847 @item Even column
11848 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableCell}
11849 @tab @samp{CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph}
11850 @item Odd column
11851 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableCell}
11852 @tab @samp{CustomOddColumnTableParagraph}
11853 @end multitable
11854
11855 To create a table template with the name @samp{Custom}, define the above
11856 styles in the
11857 @code{<office:automatic-styles>}...@code{</office:automatic-styles>} element
11858 of the content template file (@pxref{x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml,,Factory
11859 styles}).
11860
11861 @item
11862 Define a table style@footnote{See the attributes @code{table:template-name},
11863 @code{table:use-first-row-styles}, @code{table:use-last-row-styles},
11864 @code{table:use-first-column-styles}, @code{table:use-last-column-styles},
11865 @code{table:use-banding-rows-styles}, and
11866 @code{table:use-banding-column-styles} of the @code{<table:table>} element in
11867 the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification}
11868
11869 @vindex org-export-odt-table-styles
11870 To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the variable
11871 @code{org-export-odt-table-styles} and specify the following:
11872
11873 @itemize @minus
11874 @item the name of the table template created in step (1)
11875 @item the set of cell styles in that template that are to be activated
11876 @end itemize
11877
11878 For example, the entry below defines two different table styles
11879 @samp{TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn} and @samp{TableWithFirstRowandLastRow}
11880 based on the same template @samp{Custom}. The styles achieve their intended
11881 effect by selectively activating the individual cell styles in that template.
11882
11883 @lisp
11884 (setq org-export-odt-table-styles
11885 (append org-export-odt-table-styles
11886 '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom"
11887 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11888 (use-first-column-styles . t)))
11889 ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom"
11890 ((use-first-row-styles . t)
11891 (use-last-row-styles . t))))))
11892 @end lisp
11893
11894 @item
11895 Associate a table with the table style
11896
11897 To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of
11898 the @code{ATTR_ODT} line as shown below.
11899
11900 @example
11901 #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn"
11902 | Name | Phone | Age |
11903 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
11904 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
11905 @end example
11906 @end enumerate
11907
11908 @node Validating OpenDocument XML, , Customizing tables in ODT export, Advanced topics in ODT export
11909 @subsubsection Validating OpenDocument XML
11910
11911 Occasionally, you will discover that the document created by the
11912 ODT exporter cannot be opened by your favorite application. One of
11913 the common reasons for this is that the @file{.odt} file is corrupt. In such
11914 cases, you may want to validate the document against the OpenDocument RELAX
11915 NG Compact Syntax (RNC) schema.
11916
11917 For de-compressing the @file{.odt} file@footnote{@file{.odt} files are
11918 nothing but @samp{zip} archives}: @inforef{File Archives,,emacs}. For
11919 general help with validation (and schema-sensitive editing) of XML files:
11920 @inforef{Introduction,,nxml-mode}.
11921
11922 @vindex org-export-odt-schema-dir
11923 If you have ready access to OpenDocument @file{.rnc} files and the needed
11924 schema-locating rules in a single folder, you can customize the variable
11925 @code{org-export-odt-schema-dir} to point to that directory. The
11926 ODT exporter will take care of updating the
11927 @code{rng-schema-locating-files} for you.
11928
11929 @c end opendocument
11930
11931 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocument Text export, Exporting
11932 @section TaskJuggler export
11933 @cindex TaskJuggler export
11934 @cindex Project management
11935
11936 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
11937 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
11938 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
11939 you have provided.
11940
11941 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
11942 @code{HTML} and @LaTeX{} exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
11943 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
11944 document.
11945
11946 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
11947 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
11948 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
11949 all the nodes.
11950
11951 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
11952
11953 @table @kbd
11954 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
11955 Export as a TaskJuggler file.
11956
11957 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
11958 Export as a TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
11959 @end table
11960
11961 @subsection Tasks
11962
11963 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
11964 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org mode. Assign efforts to each
11965 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
11966 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
11967 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
11968 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
11969 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
11970 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
11971 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
11972 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
11973
11974 @subsection Resources
11975
11976 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
11977 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
11978 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
11979 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
11980 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
11981 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
11982 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
11983 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
11984 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
11985 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
11986 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
11987 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
11988 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
11989
11990 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
11991 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
11992 time.
11993
11994 @subsection Export of properties
11995
11996 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e., if a
11997 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
11998 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
11999 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
12000 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
12001 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
12002 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
12003 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
12004 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
12005
12006 @subsection Dependencies
12007
12008 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
12009 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
12010 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
12011 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
12012 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
12013 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
12014 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
12015 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
12016 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
12017 examples should illustrate this:
12018
12019 @example
12020 * Preparation
12021 :PROPERTIES:
12022 :task_id: preparation
12023 :ORDERED: t
12024 :END:
12025 * Training material
12026 :PROPERTIES:
12027 :task_id: training_material
12028 :ORDERED: t
12029 :END:
12030 ** Markup Guidelines
12031 :PROPERTIES:
12032 :Effort: 2d
12033 :END:
12034 ** Workflow Guidelines
12035 :PROPERTIES:
12036 :Effort: 2d
12037 :END:
12038 * Presentation
12039 :PROPERTIES:
12040 :Effort: 2d
12041 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
12042 :END:
12043 @end example
12044
12045 @subsection Reports
12046
12047 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
12048 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g., gantt chart, resource
12049 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
12050 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
12051 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
12052 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
12053 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
12054 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
12055
12056 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
12057 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
12058
12059 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
12060 @section Freemind export
12061 @cindex Freemind export
12062 @cindex mind map
12063
12064 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
12065
12066 @table @kbd
12067 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
12068 Export as a Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
12069 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
12070 @end table
12071
12072 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
12073 @section XOXO export
12074 @cindex XOXO export
12075
12076 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
12077 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
12078 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
12079
12080 @table @kbd
12081 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
12082 Export as an XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
12083 @file{myfile.html}.
12084 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
12085 Export only the visible part of the document.
12086 @end table
12087
12088 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
12089 @section iCalendar export
12090 @cindex iCalendar export
12091
12092 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
12093 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
12094 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
12095 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
12096 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
12097 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
12098 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
12099 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
12100 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
12101 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
12102 included in the export, configure the variable
12103 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
12104 and TODO items as VTODO@. It will also create events from deadlines that are
12105 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
12106 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
12107 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
12108 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
12109 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
12110 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
12111 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
12112 time.
12113
12114 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
12115 @cindex property, ID
12116 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
12117 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
12118 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
12119 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
12120 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
12121 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
12122 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
12123 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
12124 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
12125
12126 @table @kbd
12127 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
12128 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
12129 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
12130 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
12131 @vindex org-agenda-files
12132 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
12133 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
12134 file will be written.
12135 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
12136 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
12137 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
12138 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
12139 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
12140 @end table
12141
12142 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12143 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
12144 @cindex property, SUMMARY
12145 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
12146 @cindex property, LOCATION
12147 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
12148 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
12149 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
12150 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
12151 and the description from the body (limited to
12152 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
12153
12154 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
12155 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
12156
12157 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
12158 @chapter Publishing
12159 @cindex publishing
12160
12161 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
12162 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
12163 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
12164 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
12165 server.
12166
12167 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
12168 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
12169
12170 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
12171
12172 @menu
12173 * Configuration:: Defining projects
12174 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
12175 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
12176 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
12177 @end menu
12178
12179 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
12180 @section Configuration
12181
12182 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
12183 and many other properties of a project.
12184
12185 @menu
12186 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
12187 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
12188 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
12189 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
12190 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
12191 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
12192 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
12193 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
12194 @end menu
12195
12196 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
12197 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
12198 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
12199 @cindex projects, for publishing
12200
12201 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12202 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
12203 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
12204 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
12205
12206 @lisp
12207 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
12208 @r{i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
12209 @r{or}
12210 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
12211
12212 @end lisp
12213
12214 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
12215 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
12216 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
12217 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
12218 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
12219 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
12220 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
12221 sequence given.
12222
12223 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
12224 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
12225 @cindex directories, for publishing
12226
12227 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
12228 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
12229 and where to put published files.
12230
12231 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12232 @item @code{:base-directory}
12233 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
12234 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
12235 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
12236 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
12237 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
12238 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
12239 @item @code{:preparation-function}
12240 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
12241 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
12242 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
12243 variable @code{project-plist}.
12244 @item @code{:completion-function}
12245 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
12246 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
12247 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
12248 @code{project-plist}.
12249 @end multitable
12250 @noindent
12251
12252 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
12253 @subsection Selecting files
12254 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
12255
12256 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
12257 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
12258 properties
12259 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12260 @item @code{:base-extension}
12261 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
12262 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
12263 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
12264
12265 @item @code{:exclude}
12266 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
12267 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
12268 extension.
12269
12270 @item @code{:include}
12271 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
12272 and @code{:exclude}.
12273
12274 @item @code{:recursive}
12275 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
12276 @end multitable
12277
12278 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
12279 @subsection Publishing action
12280 @cindex action, for publishing
12281
12282 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
12283 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
12284 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
12285 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
12286 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
12287 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
12288 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
12289 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
12290 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
12291 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
12292 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
12293 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
12294 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
12295 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
12296 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
12297 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
12298 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
12299 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
12300 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
12301
12302 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
12303 @item @code{:publishing-function}
12304 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
12305 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
12306 @item @code{:plain-source}
12307 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
12308 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
12309 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
12310 @end multitable
12311
12312 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
12313 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
12314 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
12315 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
12316 and place the result into the destination folder.
12317
12318 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
12319 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
12320 @cindex options, for publishing
12321
12322 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
12323 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
12324 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
12325 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
12326 respective variable for details.
12327
12328 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
12329 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
12330 @vindex org-export-default-language
12331 @vindex org-display-custom-times
12332 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
12333 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
12334 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
12335 @vindex org-export-with-toc
12336 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
12337 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
12338 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
12339 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
12340 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
12341 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
12342 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
12343 @vindex org-export-with-tags
12344 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
12345 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
12346 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
12347 @vindex org-export-with-priority
12348 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
12349 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
12350 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
12351 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
12352 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
12353 @vindex org-export-author-info
12354 @vindex org-export-email-info
12355 @vindex org-export-creator-info
12356 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
12357 @vindex org-export-with-tables
12358 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
12359 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
12360 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
12361 @vindex org-export-html-style
12362 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
12363 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
12364 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
12365 @vindex org-export-html-extension
12366 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
12367 @vindex org-export-html-expand
12368 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
12369 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
12370 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
12371 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
12372 @vindex user-full-name
12373 @vindex user-mail-address
12374 @vindex org-export-select-tags
12375 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
12376
12377 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
12378 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
12379 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
12380 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
12381 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
12382 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
12383 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
12384 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
12385 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
12386 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
12387 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
12388 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
12389 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
12390 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
12391 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
12392 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
12393 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
12394 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
12395 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
12396 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
12397 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
12398 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
12399 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
12400 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
12401 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
12402 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
12403 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
12404 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
12405 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
12406 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
12407 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
12408 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
12409 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
12410 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
12411 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
12412 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
12413 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
12414 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
12415 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
12416 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
12417 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
12418 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
12419 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
12420 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
12421 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
12422 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
12423 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
12424 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
12425 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
12426 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
12427 @end multitable
12428
12429 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
12430 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
12431 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
12432 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
12433 options.
12434
12435
12436
12437 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
12438 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
12439 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
12440 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
12441 options}), however, override everything.
12442
12443 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
12444 @subsection Links between published files
12445 @cindex links, publishing
12446
12447 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
12448 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
12449 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
12450 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
12451 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
12452 you publish them to HTML@. If you also publish the Org source file and want
12453 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
12454 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
12455 @file{html} file.
12456
12457 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
12458 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
12459 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
12460 an example of this usage.
12461
12462 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
12463 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
12464 location. In this case, use the property
12465
12466 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
12467 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
12468 @tab Function to validate links
12469 @end multitable
12470
12471 @noindent
12472 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
12473 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
12474 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
12475 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
12476 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
12477 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
12478 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
12479
12480 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
12481 @subsection Generating a sitemap
12482 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
12483
12484 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
12485 a map of files for a given project.
12486
12487 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
12488 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
12489 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
12490 or @code{org-publish-all}.
12491
12492 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
12493 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
12494 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
12495
12496 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
12497 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
12498
12499 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
12500 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
12501 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
12502 of links to all files in the project.
12503
12504 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
12505 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
12506 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
12507 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
12508
12509 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
12510 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
12511 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
12512 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
12513 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
12514 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
12515 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
12516
12517 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
12518 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
12519
12520 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
12521 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formatted in the
12522 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
12523 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
12524 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
12525 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formatted with
12526 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
12527
12528 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
12529 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
12530 a sitemap entry's date is to be formatted. This property bypasses
12531 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
12532
12533 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
12534 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
12535 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
12536 Defaults to @code{nil}.
12537
12538 @end multitable
12539
12540 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
12541 @subsection Generating an index
12542 @cindex index, in a publishing project
12543
12544 Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
12545
12546 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12547 @item @code{:makeindex}
12548 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
12549 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
12550 @end multitable
12551
12552 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
12553 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+INCLUDE:
12554 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
12555 a title, style information, etc.
12556
12557 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
12558 @section Uploading files
12559 @cindex rsync
12560 @cindex unison
12561
12562 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
12563 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
12564 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
12565 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
12566 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
12567 under heavy usage.
12568
12569 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
12570 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
12571 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
12572 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
12573 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
12574
12575 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
12576 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
12577 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
12578 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
12579 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
12580 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
12581 tool syncs them.
12582
12583 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
12584 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
12585 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
12586 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
12587 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE:}. The timestamp mechanism in
12588 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
12589
12590 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
12591 @section Sample configuration
12592
12593 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
12594 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
12595 more complex, with a multi-component project.
12596
12597 @menu
12598 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
12599 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
12600 @end menu
12601
12602 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
12603 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
12604
12605 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
12606 directory on the local machine.
12607
12608 @lisp
12609 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12610 '(("org"
12611 :base-directory "~/org/"
12612 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
12613 :section-numbers nil
12614 :table-of-contents nil
12615 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12616 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
12617 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
12618 @end lisp
12619
12620 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
12621 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
12622
12623 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
12624 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
12625 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
12626 excluded.
12627
12628 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
12629 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
12630 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
12631 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
12632 @c
12633 @example
12634 file:../images/myimage.png
12635 @end example
12636 @c
12637 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
12638 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
12639 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
12640
12641 @lisp
12642 (setq org-publish-project-alist
12643 '(("orgfiles"
12644 :base-directory "~/org/"
12645 :base-extension "org"
12646 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
12647 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
12648 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
12649 :headline-levels 3
12650 :section-numbers nil
12651 :table-of-contents nil
12652 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
12653 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
12654 :html-preamble t)
12655
12656 ("images"
12657 :base-directory "~/images/"
12658 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
12659 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
12660 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12661
12662 ("other"
12663 :base-directory "~/other/"
12664 :base-extension "css\\|el"
12665 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
12666 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
12667 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
12668 @end lisp
12669
12670 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
12671 @section Triggering publication
12672
12673 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
12674
12675 @table @kbd
12676 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
12677 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
12678 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
12679 Publish the project containing the current file.
12680 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
12681 Publish only the current file.
12682 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
12683 Publish every project.
12684 @end table
12685
12686 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
12687 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
12688 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
12689 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
12690 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
12691 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
12692 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
12693
12694 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12695 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12696
12697 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
12698 @chapter Working with source code
12699 @cindex Schulte, Eric
12700 @cindex Davison, Dan
12701 @cindex source code, working with
12702
12703 Source code can be included in Org mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
12704 e.g.:
12705
12706 @example
12707 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
12708 (defun org-xor (a b)
12709 "Exclusive or."
12710 (if a (not b) b))
12711 #+END_SRC
12712 @end example
12713
12714 Org mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
12715 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
12716 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
12717 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
12718 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
12719 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
12720
12721 The following sections describe Org mode's code block handling facilities.
12722
12723 @menu
12724 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
12725 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
12726 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
12727 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
12728 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer
12729 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
12730 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
12731 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
12732 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
12733 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode
12734 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
12735 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
12736 @end menu
12737
12738 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12739 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12740
12741 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
12742 @section Structure of code blocks
12743 @cindex code block, structure
12744 @cindex source code, block structure
12745 @cindex #+NAME
12746 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
12747
12748 Live code blocks can be specified with a @samp{src} block or
12749 inline.@footnote{Note that @samp{src} blocks may be inserted using Org mode's
12750 @ref{Easy Templates} system} The structure of a @samp{src} block is
12751
12752 @example
12753 #+NAME: <name>
12754 #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments>
12755 <body>
12756 #+END_SRC
12757 @end example
12758
12759 The @code{#+NAME:} line is optional, and can be used to name the code
12760 block. Live code blocks require that a language be specified on the
12761 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line. Switches and header arguments are optional.
12762 @cindex source code, inline
12763
12764 Live code blocks can also be specified inline using
12765
12766 @example
12767 src_<language>@{<body>@}
12768 @end example
12769
12770 or
12771
12772 @example
12773 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
12774 @end example
12775
12776 @table @code
12777 @item <#+NAME: name>
12778 This line associates a name with the code block. This is similar to the
12779 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} lines that can be used to name tables in Org mode
12780 files. Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate
12781 the block from other places in the file, from other files, or from Org mode
12782 table formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique
12783 and the behavior of Org mode when two or more blocks share the same name is
12784 undefined.
12785 @cindex #+NAME
12786 @item <language>
12787 The language of the code in the block (see @ref{Languages}).
12788 @cindex source code, language
12789 @item <switches>
12790 Optional switches control code block export (see the discussion of switches in
12791 @ref{Literal examples})
12792 @cindex source code, switches
12793 @item <header arguments>
12794 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
12795 tangling of code blocks (see @ref{Header arguments}).
12796 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
12797 basis using properties.
12798 @item source code, header arguments
12799 @item <body>
12800 Source code in the specified language.
12801 @end table
12802
12803 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12804 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12805
12806 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
12807 @section Editing source code
12808 @cindex code block, editing
12809 @cindex source code, editing
12810
12811 @kindex C-c '
12812 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
12813 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
12814 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
12815 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
12816
12817 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
12818 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
12819 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
12820 further configuration options.
12821
12822 @table @code
12823 @item org-src-lang-modes
12824 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
12825 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
12826 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
12827 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
12828 @item org-src-window-setup
12829 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
12830 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
12831 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
12832 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
12833 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
12834 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
12835 variable to nil to switch without asking.
12836 @end table
12837
12838 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
12839 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
12840
12841 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12842 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12843
12844 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
12845 @section Exporting code blocks
12846 @cindex code block, exporting
12847 @cindex source code, exporting
12848
12849 It is possible to export the @emph{code} of code blocks, the @emph{results}
12850 of code block evaluation, @emph{both} the code and the results of code block
12851 evaluation, or @emph{none}. For most languages, the default exports code.
12852 However, for some languages (e.g., @code{ditaa}) the default exports the
12853 results of code block evaluation. For information on exporting code block
12854 bodies, see @ref{Literal examples}.
12855
12856 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
12857 behavior:
12858
12859 @subsubheading Header arguments:
12860 @table @code
12861 @item :exports code
12862 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
12863 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
12864 @item :exports results
12865 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
12866 Org mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
12867 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
12868 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
12869 block will not be exported.
12870 @item :exports both
12871 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
12872 @item :exports none
12873 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
12874 @end table
12875
12876 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
12877 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
12878 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
12879 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org mode files are
12880 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org mode is used as the
12881 markup language for a wiki.
12882
12883 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12884 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12885 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
12886 @section Extracting source code
12887 @cindex tangling
12888 @cindex source code, extracting
12889 @cindex code block, extracting source code
12890
12891 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
12892 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
12893 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
12894 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
12895 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
12896
12897 @subsubheading Header arguments
12898 @table @code
12899 @item :tangle no
12900 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
12901 @item :tangle yes
12902 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
12903 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
12904 for the block language.
12905 @item :tangle filename
12906 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
12907 @end table
12908
12909 @kindex C-c C-v t
12910 @subsubheading Functions
12911 @table @code
12912 @item org-babel-tangle
12913 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
12914 @item org-babel-tangle-file
12915 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
12916 @end table
12917
12918 @subsubheading Hooks
12919 @table @code
12920 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
12921 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
12922 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
12923 of tangled code files.
12924 @end table
12925
12926 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
12927 @section Evaluating code blocks
12928 @cindex code block, evaluating
12929 @cindex source code, evaluating
12930 @cindex #+RESULTS
12931
12932 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
12933 potential for that code to do harm. Org mode provides safeguards to ensure
12934 that code is only evaluated after explicit confirmation from the user. For
12935 information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see @ref{Code
12936 evaluation security}.} and the results of evaluation optionally placed in the
12937 Org mode buffer. The results of evaluation are placed following a line that
12938 begins by default with @code{#+RESULTS} and optionally a cache identifier
12939 and/or the name of the evaluated code block. The default value of
12940 @code{#+RESULTS} can be changed with the customizable variable
12941 @code{org-babel-results-keyword}.
12942
12943 By default, the evaluation facility is only enabled for Lisp code blocks
12944 specified as @code{emacs-lisp}. However, source code blocks in many languages
12945 can be evaluated within Org mode (see @ref{Languages} for a list of supported
12946 languages and @ref{Structure of code blocks} for information on the syntax
12947 used to define a code block).
12948
12949 @kindex C-c C-c
12950 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
12951 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
12952 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
12953 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
12954 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
12955 its results into the Org mode buffer.
12956 @cindex #+CALL
12957
12958 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an Org
12959 mode buffer or an Org mode table. Live code blocks located in the current
12960 Org mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel'' (see @ref{Library of Babel})
12961 can be executed. Named code blocks can be executed with a separate
12962 @code{#+CALL:} line or inline within a block of text.
12963
12964 The syntax of the @code{#+CALL:} line is
12965
12966 @example
12967 #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>)
12968 #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments>
12969 @end example
12970
12971 The syntax for inline evaluation of named code blocks is
12972
12973 @example
12974 ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...
12975 ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ...
12976 @end example
12977
12978 @table @code
12979 @item <name>
12980 The name of the code block to be evaluated (see @ref{Structure of code blocks}).
12981 @item <arguments>
12982 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
12983 arguments use standard function call syntax, rather than
12984 header argument syntax. For example, a @code{#+CALL:} line that passes the
12985 number four to a code block named @code{double}, which declares the header
12986 argument @code{:var n=2}, would be written as @code{#+CALL: double(n=4)}.
12987 @item <inside header arguments>
12988 Inside header arguments are passed through and applied to the named code
12989 block. These arguments use header argument syntax rather than standard
12990 function call syntax. Inside header arguments affect how the code block is
12991 evaluated. For example, @code{[:results output]} will collect the results of
12992 everything printed to @code{STDOUT} during execution of the code block.
12993 @item <end header arguments>
12994 End header arguments are applied to the calling instance and do not affect
12995 evaluation of the named code block. They affect how the results are
12996 incorporated into the Org mode buffer and how the call line is exported. For
12997 example, @code{:results html} will insert the results of the call line
12998 evaluation in the Org buffer, wrapped in a @code{BEGIN_HTML:} block.
12999
13000 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+CALL:} lines see
13001 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
13002 @end table
13003
13004 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
13005 @section Library of Babel
13006 @cindex babel, library of
13007 @cindex source code, library
13008 @cindex code block, library
13009
13010 The ``Library of Babel'' consists of code blocks that can be called from any
13011 Org mode file. Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called
13012 remotely as if they were in the current Org mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating
13013 code blocks} for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
13014
13015
13016 The central repository of code blocks in the ``Library of Babel'' is housed
13017 in an Org mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org mode.
13018
13019 Users can add code blocks they believe to be generally useful to their
13020 ``Library of Babel.'' The code blocks can be stored in any Org mode file and
13021 then loaded into the library with @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}.
13022
13023
13024 @kindex C-c C-v i
13025 Code blocks located in any Org mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
13026 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
13027 i}.
13028
13029 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
13030 @section Languages
13031 @cindex babel, languages
13032 @cindex source code, languages
13033 @cindex code block, languages
13034
13035 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
13036
13037 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
13038 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
13039 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
13040 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
13041 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
13042 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
13043 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
13044 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
13045 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
13046 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
13047 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
13048 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
13049 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
13050 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org mode @tab org
13051 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
13052 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
13053 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
13054 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
13055 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
13056 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
13057 @end multitable
13058
13059 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
13060 available, it can be found at
13061 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html}.
13062
13063 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
13064 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
13065 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
13066 to your emacs configuration.
13067
13068 @quotation
13069 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
13070 @code{R} code blocks.
13071 @end quotation
13072
13073 @lisp
13074 (org-babel-do-load-languages
13075 'org-babel-load-languages
13076 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
13077 (R . t)))
13078 @end lisp
13079
13080 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
13081 elisp file with @code{require}.
13082
13083 @quotation
13084 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
13085 @end quotation
13086
13087 @lisp
13088 (require 'ob-clojure)
13089 @end lisp
13090
13091 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
13092 @section Header arguments
13093 @cindex code block, header arguments
13094 @cindex source code, block header arguments
13095
13096 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
13097 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
13098 describes each header argument in detail.
13099
13100 @menu
13101 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
13102 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
13103 @end menu
13104
13105 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
13106 @subsection Using header arguments
13107
13108 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
13109 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
13110 @menu
13111 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
13112 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
13113 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
13114 * Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
13115 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
13116 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
13117 @end menu
13118
13119
13120 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
13121 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
13122 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13123 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
13124 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
13125
13126 @example
13127 :session => "none"
13128 :results => "replace"
13129 :exports => "code"
13130 :cache => "no"
13131 :noweb => "no"
13132 @end example
13133
13134 @c @example
13135 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
13136 @c Its value is
13137 @c ((:session . "none")
13138 @c (:results . "replace")
13139 @c (:exports . "code")
13140 @c (:cache . "no")
13141 @c (:noweb . "no"))
13142
13143
13144 @c Documentation:
13145 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
13146 @c @end example
13147
13148 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
13149 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
13150 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
13151 blocks.
13152
13153 @lisp
13154 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
13155 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
13156 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
13157 @end lisp
13158
13159 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13160 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
13161 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
13162 language-specific documentation available online at
13163 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
13164
13165 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13166 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
13167 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified as properties through the use
13168 of @code{#+PROPERTY:} lines placed anywhere in an Org mode file (see
13169 @ref{Property syntax}).
13170
13171 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
13172 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
13173 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
13174 inserted into the buffer.
13175
13176 @example
13177 #+PROPERTY: session *R*
13178 #+PROPERTY: results silent
13179 @end example
13180
13181 @node Header arguments in Org mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
13182 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org mode properties
13183
13184 Header arguments are also read from Org mode properties (see @ref{Property
13185 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
13186 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
13187
13188 @example
13189 #+PROPERTY: tangle yes
13190 @end example
13191
13192 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
13193 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
13194 with inheritance, regardless of the value of
13195 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. In the following example the value of
13196 the @code{:cache} header argument will default to @code{yes} in all code
13197 blocks in the subtree rooted at the following heading:
13198
13199 @example
13200 * outline header
13201 :PROPERTIES:
13202 :cache: yes
13203 :END:
13204 @end example
13205
13206 @kindex C-c C-x p
13207 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
13208 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
13209 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
13210 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
13211 in Org mode documents.
13212
13213 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org mode properties, Using header arguments
13214 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
13215
13216 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
13217 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
13218 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line.
13219 Properties set in this way override both the values of
13220 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
13221 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
13222 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
13223 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
13224 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
13225 preserved on export to HTML or @LaTeX{}.
13226
13227 @example
13228 #+NAME: factorial
13229 #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
13230 fac 0 = 1
13231 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
13232 #+END_SRC
13233 @end example
13234 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks
13235
13236 @example
13237 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
13238 @end example
13239
13240 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using @code{#+HEADER:} or
13241 @code{#+HEADERS:} lines preceding a code block or nested between the
13242 @code{#+NAME:} line and the @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} line of a named code block.
13243 @cindex #+HEADER:
13244 @cindex #+HEADERS:
13245
13246 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
13247
13248 @example
13249 #+HEADERS: :var data1=1
13250 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2
13251 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
13252 #+END_SRC
13253
13254 #+RESULTS:
13255 : data1:1, data2:2
13256 @end example
13257
13258 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
13259
13260 @example
13261 #+NAME: named-block
13262 #+HEADER: :var data=2
13263 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13264 (message "data:%S" data)
13265 #+END_SRC
13266
13267 #+RESULTS: named-block
13268 : data:2
13269 @end example
13270
13271 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
13272 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
13273 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
13274
13275 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
13276 @code{#+CALL:} lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
13277 information on the structure of @code{#+CALL:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
13278 blocks}.
13279
13280 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
13281 evaluation of the @code{#+CALL:} line.
13282
13283 @example
13284 #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results
13285 @end example
13286
13287 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
13288 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
13289
13290 @example
13291 #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5)
13292 @end example
13293
13294 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
13295 @subsection Specific header arguments
13296 Header arguments consist of an initial colon followed by the name of the
13297 argument in lowercase letters. The following header arguments are defined:
13298
13299 @menu
13300 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
13301 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
13302 be collected and handled
13303 * file:: Specify a path for file output
13304 * file-desc:: Specify a description for file results
13305 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
13306 directory for code block execution
13307 * exports:: Export code and/or results
13308 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
13309 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
13310 files during tangling
13311 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
13312 code files
13313 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
13314 code files
13315 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
13316 expansion during tangling
13317 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
13318 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
13319 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
13320 * noweb-sep:: String used to separate noweb references
13321 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
13322 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
13323 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
13324 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
13325 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
13326 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
13327 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
13328 * wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results
13329 @end menu
13330
13331 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
13332 @ref{Languages}.
13333
13334 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
13335 @subsubsection @code{:var}
13336 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
13337 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
13338 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
13339 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. In every
13340 case, variables require a default value when they are declared.
13341
13342 The values passed to arguments can either be literal values, references, or
13343 Emacs Lisp code (see @ref{var, Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables}). References
13344 include anything in the Org mode file that takes a @code{#+NAME:},
13345 @code{#+TBLNAME:}, or @code{#+RESULTS:} line. This includes tables, lists,
13346 @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE} blocks, other code blocks, and the results of other
13347 code blocks.
13348
13349 Argument values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays (see @ref{var,
13350 Indexable variable values}).
13351
13352 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
13353 @code{:var} header argument.
13354
13355 @example
13356 :var name=assign
13357 @end example
13358
13359 The argument, @code{assign}, can either be a literal value, such as a string
13360 @samp{"string"} or a number @samp{9}, or a reference to a table, a list, a
13361 literal example, another code block (with or without arguments), or the
13362 results of evaluating another code block.
13363
13364 Here are examples of passing values by reference:
13365
13366 @table @dfn
13367
13368 @item table
13369 an Org mode table named with either a @code{#+NAME:} or @code{#+TBLNAME:} line
13370
13371 @example
13372 #+TBLNAME: example-table
13373 | 1 |
13374 | 2 |
13375 | 3 |
13376 | 4 |
13377
13378 #+NAME: table-length
13379 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
13380 (length table)
13381 #+END_SRC
13382
13383 #+RESULTS: table-length
13384 : 4
13385 @end example
13386
13387 @item list
13388 a simple list named with a @code{#+NAME:} line (note that nesting is not
13389 carried through to the source code block)
13390
13391 @example
13392 #+NAME: example-list
13393 - simple
13394 - not
13395 - nested
13396 - list
13397
13398 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list
13399 (print x)
13400 #+END_SRC
13401
13402 #+RESULTS:
13403 | simple | list |
13404 @end example
13405
13406 @item code block without arguments
13407 a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by @code{#+NAME:},
13408 optionally followed by parentheses
13409
13410 @example
13411 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
13412 (* 2 length)
13413 #+END_SRC
13414
13415 #+RESULTS:
13416 : 8
13417 @end example
13418
13419 @item code block with arguments
13420 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+NAME:}, followed by parentheses and
13421 optional arguments passed within the parentheses following the
13422 code block name using standard function call syntax
13423
13424 @example
13425 #+NAME: double
13426 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8
13427 (* 2 input)
13428 #+END_SRC
13429
13430 #+RESULTS: double
13431 : 16
13432
13433 #+NAME: squared
13434 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
13435 (* input input)
13436 #+END_SRC
13437
13438 #+RESULTS: squared
13439 : 4
13440 @end example
13441
13442 @item literal example
13443 a literal example block named with a @code{#+NAME:} line
13444
13445 @example
13446 #+NAME: literal-example
13447 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
13448 A literal example
13449 on two lines
13450 #+END_EXAMPLE
13451
13452 #+NAME: read-literal-example
13453 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example
13454 (concatenate 'string x " for you.")
13455 #+END_SRC
13456
13457 #+RESULTS: read-literal-example
13458 : A literal example
13459 : on two lines for you.
13460
13461 @end example
13462
13463 @end table
13464
13465 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
13466 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
13467 using the @code{#+NAME:} line of a code block. As in the following
13468 example, arguments can be packed inside of parentheses, separated by commas,
13469 following the source name.
13470
13471 @example
13472 #+NAME: double(input=0, x=2)
13473 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13474 (* 2 (+ input x))
13475 #+END_SRC
13476 @end example
13477
13478 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
13479 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
13480 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
13481 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
13482 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
13483 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
13484 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
13485 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
13486 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
13487
13488 @example
13489 #+NAME: example-table
13490 | 1 | a |
13491 | 2 | b |
13492 | 3 | c |
13493 | 4 | d |
13494
13495 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
13496 data
13497 #+END_SRC
13498
13499 #+RESULTS:
13500 : a
13501 @end example
13502
13503 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
13504 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
13505 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
13506 to @code{data}.
13507
13508 @example
13509 #+NAME: example-table
13510 | 1 | a |
13511 | 2 | b |
13512 | 3 | c |
13513 | 4 | d |
13514 | 5 | 3 |
13515
13516 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
13517 data
13518 #+END_SRC
13519
13520 #+RESULTS:
13521 | 2 | b |
13522 | 3 | c |
13523 | 4 | d |
13524 @end example
13525
13526 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
13527 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
13528 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
13529 column is referenced.
13530
13531 @example
13532 #+NAME: example-table
13533 | 1 | a |
13534 | 2 | b |
13535 | 3 | c |
13536 | 4 | d |
13537
13538 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
13539 data
13540 #+END_SRC
13541
13542 #+RESULTS:
13543 | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 |
13544 @end example
13545
13546 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
13547 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
13548 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
13549
13550 @example
13551 #+NAME: 3D
13552 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
13553 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
13554 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
13555 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
13556 #+END_SRC
13557
13558 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
13559 data
13560 #+END_SRC
13561
13562 #+RESULTS:
13563 | 11 | 14 | 17 |
13564 @end example
13565
13566 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
13567
13568 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
13569 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be
13570 evaluated as Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as
13571 the variable value. The following example demonstrates use of this
13572 evaluation to reliably pass the file-name of the Org mode buffer to a code
13573 block---note that evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place
13574 in the original Org mode file, while there is no such guarantee for
13575 evaluation of the code block body.
13576
13577 @example
13578 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
13579 wc -w $filename
13580 #+END_SRC
13581 @end example
13582
13583 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
13584 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
13585
13586 @example
13587 #+NAME: table
13588 | (a b c) |
13589
13590 #+HEADERS: :var data=table[0,0]
13591 #+BEGIN_SRC perl
13592 $data
13593 #+END_SRC
13594
13595 #+RESULTS:
13596 : (a b c)
13597 @end example
13598
13599 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
13600 @subsubsection @code{:results}
13601
13602 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
13603 per class may be supplied per code block.
13604
13605 @itemize @bullet
13606 @item
13607 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
13608 from the code block
13609 @item
13610 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
13611 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
13612 Org mode buffer
13613 @item
13614 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
13615 block should be handled.
13616 @end itemize
13617
13618 @subsubheading Collection
13619 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
13620 should be collected from the code block.
13621
13622 @itemize @bullet
13623 @item @code{value}
13624 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
13625 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
13626 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
13627 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
13628 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
13629 @item @code{output}
13630 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
13631 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
13632 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
13633 @end itemize
13634
13635 @subsubheading Type
13636
13637 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
13638 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
13639 table or scalar depending on their value.
13640
13641 @itemize @bullet
13642 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
13643 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode table. If a single value is
13644 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
13645 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
13646 @item @code{list}
13647 The results should be interpreted as an Org mode list. If a single scalar
13648 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
13649 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
13650 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
13651 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org mode
13652 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
13653 @item @code{file}
13654 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
13655 into the Org mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
13656 @item @code{raw}
13657 The results are interpreted as raw Org mode code and are inserted directly
13658 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
13659 such by Org mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
13660 @item @code{org}
13661 The results are will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_SRC org} block.
13662 They are not comma-escaped by default but they will be if you hit @kbd{TAB}
13663 in the block and/or if you export the file. E.g., @code{:results value org}.
13664 @item @code{html}
13665 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_HTML}
13666 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
13667 @item @code{latex}
13668 Results assumed to be @LaTeX{} and are enclosed in a @code{BEGIN_LaTeX} block.
13669 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
13670 @item @code{code}
13671 Result are assumed to be parsable code and are enclosed in a code block.
13672 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
13673 @item @code{pp}
13674 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
13675 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
13676 @code{:results value pp}.
13677 @item @code{drawer}
13678 The result is wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. This can be useful for
13679 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
13680 extent is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
13681 @end itemize
13682
13683 @subsubheading Handling
13684 The following results options indicate what happens with the
13685 results once they are collected.
13686
13687 @itemize @bullet
13688 @item @code{silent}
13689 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
13690 the Org mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
13691 @item @code{replace}
13692 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
13693 will be inserted into the Org mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
13694 @code{:results output replace}.
13695 @item @code{append}
13696 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13697 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13698 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13699 @item @code{prepend}
13700 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
13701 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
13702 inserted as with @code{replace}.
13703 @end itemize
13704
13705 @node file, file-desc, results, Specific header arguments
13706 @subsubsection @code{:file}
13707
13708 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
13709 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org mode style
13710 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
13711 into the Org mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
13712 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
13713 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
13714 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
13715 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
13716
13717 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
13718 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
13719 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
13720
13721 @node file-desc, dir, file, Specific header arguments
13722 @subsubsection @code{:file-desc}
13723
13724 The value of the @code{:file-desc} header argument is used to provide a
13725 description for file code block results which are inserted as Org mode links
13726 (see @ref{Link format}). If the @code{:file-desc} header argument is given
13727 with no value the link path will be placed in both the ``link'' and the
13728 ``description'' portion of the Org mode link.
13729
13730 @node dir, exports, file-desc, Specific header arguments
13731 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
13732
13733 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
13734 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
13735 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
13736 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
13737 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
13738 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
13739 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
13740
13741 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
13742 (e.g., @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
13743 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
13744
13745 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
13746 in your home directory, you could use
13747
13748 @example
13749 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
13750 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
13751 #+END_SRC
13752 @end example
13753
13754 @subsubheading Remote execution
13755 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
13756 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
13757
13758 @example
13759 #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
13760 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
13761 #+END_SRC
13762 @end example
13763
13764 Text results will be returned to the local Org mode buffer as usual, and file
13765 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
13766 relative to the remote directory. An Org mode link to the remote file will be
13767 created.
13768
13769 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
13770 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
13771
13772 @example
13773 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
13774 @end example
13775
13776 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
13777 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
13778 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
13779 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
13780
13781 @subsubheading Further points
13782
13783 @itemize @bullet
13784 @item
13785 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
13786 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
13787 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
13788 @item
13789 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
13790 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
13791 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
13792 links inserted into the buffer will @emph{not} be expanded against @code{default
13793 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
13794 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
13795 which the link does not point.
13796 @end itemize
13797
13798 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
13799 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
13800
13801 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
13802 or @LaTeX{} exports of the Org mode file.
13803
13804 @itemize @bullet
13805 @item @code{code}
13806 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
13807 @code{:exports code}.
13808 @item @code{results}
13809 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
13810 @code{:exports results}.
13811 @item @code{both}
13812 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
13813 @code{:exports both}.
13814 @item @code{none}
13815 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
13816 @end itemize
13817
13818 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
13819 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
13820
13821 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
13822 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
13823
13824 @itemize @bullet
13825 @item @code{tangle}
13826 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
13827 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org mode file.
13828 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
13829 @item @code{no}
13830 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
13831 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
13832 @item other
13833 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
13834 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org mode
13835 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
13836 @end itemize
13837
13838 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
13839 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
13840
13841 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
13842 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
13843 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
13844
13845 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
13846 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
13847 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
13848 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
13849 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
13850 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
13851
13852 @itemize @bullet
13853 @item @code{no}
13854 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
13855 @item @code{link}
13856 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
13857 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
13858 @item @code{yes}
13859 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
13860 @item @code{org}
13861 Include text from the Org mode file as a comment.
13862
13863 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
13864 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
13865 @item @code{both}
13866 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
13867 @item @code{noweb}
13868 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
13869 references in the code block body in link comments.
13870 @end itemize
13871
13872 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
13873 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
13874 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
13875 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
13876 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
13877 are accepted.
13878
13879 @itemize @bullet
13880 @item @code{yes}
13881 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
13882 @item @code{no}
13883 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
13884 @end itemize
13885
13886 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
13887 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
13888
13889 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13890 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
13891 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
13892 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
13893 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
13894
13895 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
13896 @subsubsection @code{:session}
13897
13898 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
13899 language where state is preserved.
13900
13901 By default, a session is not started.
13902
13903 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
13904 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
13905 interpreted language.
13906
13907 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
13908 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
13909
13910 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' syntax
13911 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) when the code block is
13912 evaluated, tangled, or exported. The @code{:noweb} header argument can have
13913 one of the five values: @code{no}, @code{yes}, @code{tangle}, or
13914 @code{no-export} @code{strip-export}.
13915
13916 @itemize @bullet
13917 @item @code{no}
13918 The default. ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will
13919 not be expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13920 @item @code{yes}
13921 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
13922 expanded before the code block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
13923 @item @code{tangle}
13924 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13925 before the code block is tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax references will
13926 not be expanded when the code block is evaluated or exported.
13927 @item @code{no-export}
13928 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13929 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13930 references will not be expanded when the code block is exported.
13931 @item @code{strip-export}
13932 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be expanded
13933 before the block is evaluated or tangled. However, ``noweb'' syntax
13934 references will not be removed when the code block is exported.
13935 @item @code{eval}
13936 ``Noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will only be
13937 expanded before the block is evaluated.
13938 @end itemize
13939
13940 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
13941 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
13942 @code{<<reference>>}.
13943 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
13944 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
13945 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
13946
13947 This code block:
13948
13949 @example
13950 -- <<example>>
13951 @end example
13952
13953 expands to:
13954
13955 @example
13956 -- this is the
13957 -- multi-line body of example
13958 @end example
13959
13960 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
13961 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
13962 references.
13963
13964 @node noweb-ref, noweb-sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
13965 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
13966 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
13967 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
13968 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
13969 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
13970
13971 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
13972 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
13973 following Org mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
13974 the resulting pure code file@footnote{(The example needs property inheritance
13975 to be turned on for the @code{noweb-ref} property, see @ref{Property
13976 inheritance}).}.
13977
13978 @example
13979 #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
13980 <<fullest-disk>>
13981 #+END_SRC
13982 * the mount point of the fullest disk
13983 :PROPERTIES:
13984 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
13985 :END:
13986
13987 ** query all mounted disks
13988 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13989 df \
13990 #+END_SRC
13991
13992 ** strip the header row
13993 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13994 |sed '1d' \
13995 #+END_SRC
13996
13997 ** sort by the percent full
13998 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
13999 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
14000 #+END_SRC
14001
14002 ** extract the mount point
14003 #+BEGIN_SRC sh
14004 |awk '@{print $2@}'
14005 #+END_SRC
14006 @end example
14007
14008 The @code{:noweb-sep} (see @ref{noweb-sep}) header argument holds the string
14009 used to separate accumulate noweb references like those above. By default a
14010 newline is used.
14011
14012 @node noweb-sep, cache, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
14013 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-sep}
14014
14015 The @code{:noweb-sep} header argument holds the string used to separate
14016 accumulate noweb references (see @ref{noweb-ref}). By default a newline is
14017 used.
14018
14019 @node cache, sep, noweb-sep, Specific header arguments
14020 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
14021
14022 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
14023 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
14024 unchanged code blocks. Note that the @code{:cache} header argument will not
14025 attempt to cache results when the @code{:session} header argument is used,
14026 because the results of the code block execution may be stored in the session
14027 outside of the Org mode buffer. The @code{:cache} header argument can have
14028 one of two values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
14029
14030 @itemize @bullet
14031 @item @code{no}
14032 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
14033 every time it is called.
14034 @item @code{yes}
14035 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
14036 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
14037 @code{#+RESULTS:} line and will be checked on subsequent
14038 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
14039 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
14040 @end itemize
14041
14042 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
14043 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
14044 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
14045 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
14046 changed since it was last run.
14047
14048 @example
14049 #+NAME: random
14050 #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes
14051 runif(1)
14052 #+END_SRC
14053
14054 #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
14055 0.4659510825295
14056
14057 #+NAME: caller
14058 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
14059 x
14060 #+END_SRC
14061
14062 #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
14063 0.254227238707244
14064 @end example
14065
14066 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
14067 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
14068
14069 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
14070 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org mode. This is used
14071 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
14072 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
14073 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
14074 header argument.
14075
14076 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
14077 delimited.
14078
14079 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
14080 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
14081
14082 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
14083 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
14084 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14085
14086 @itemize @bullet
14087 @item @code{no}
14088 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
14089 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
14090 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
14091 default value yields the following results.
14092
14093 @example
14094 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14095 | a | b | c |
14096 |---+---+---|
14097 | d | e | f |
14098 |---+---+---|
14099 | g | h | i |
14100
14101 #+NAME: echo-table
14102 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols
14103 return tab
14104 #+END_SRC
14105
14106 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14107 | a | b | c |
14108 | d | e | f |
14109 | g | h | i |
14110 @end example
14111
14112 @item @code{yes}
14113 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
14114
14115 @example
14116 #+TBLNAME: many-cols
14117 | a | b | c |
14118 |---+---+---|
14119 | d | e | f |
14120 |---+---+---|
14121 | g | h | i |
14122
14123 #+NAME: echo-table
14124 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
14125 return tab
14126 #+END_SRC
14127
14128 #+RESULTS: echo-table
14129 | a | b | c |
14130 |---+---+---|
14131 | d | e | f |
14132 |---+---+---|
14133 | g | h | i |
14134 @end example
14135 @end itemize
14136
14137 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
14138 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
14139
14140 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
14141 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
14142 Note that the behavior of the @code{:colnames} header argument may differ
14143 across languages. For example Emacs Lisp code blocks ignore the
14144 @code{:colnames} header argument entirely given the ease with which tables
14145 with column names may be handled directly in Emacs Lisp.
14146
14147 @itemize @bullet
14148 @item @code{nil}
14149 If an input table looks like it has column names
14150 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
14151 names will be removed from the table before
14152 processing, then reapplied to the results.
14153
14154 @example
14155 #+TBLNAME: less-cols
14156 | a |
14157 |---|
14158 | b |
14159 | c |
14160
14161 #+NAME: echo-table-again
14162 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols
14163 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
14164 #+END_SRC
14165
14166 #+RESULTS: echo-table-again
14167 | a |
14168 |----|
14169 | b* |
14170 | c* |
14171 @end example
14172
14173 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
14174 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14175
14176 @item @code{no}
14177 No column name pre-processing takes place
14178
14179 @item @code{yes}
14180 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
14181 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e., the second row is not an
14182 hline)
14183 @end itemize
14184
14185 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
14186 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
14187
14188 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
14189 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
14190
14191 @itemize @bullet
14192 @item @code{no}
14193 No row name pre-processing will take place.
14194
14195 @item @code{yes}
14196 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
14197 and is then reapplied to the results.
14198
14199 @example
14200 #+TBLNAME: with-rownames
14201 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
14202 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
14203
14204 #+NAME: echo-table-once-again
14205 #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
14206 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
14207 #+END_SRC
14208
14209 #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again
14210 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
14211 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
14212 @end example
14213
14214 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
14215 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
14216
14217 @end itemize
14218
14219 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
14220 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
14221
14222 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
14223 (e.g., @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
14224 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
14225 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
14226
14227 @node eval, wrap, shebang, Specific header arguments
14228 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
14229 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
14230 specific code blocks. The @code{:eval} header argument can be useful for
14231 protecting against the evaluation of dangerous code blocks or to ensure that
14232 evaluation will require a query regardless of the value of the
14233 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable. The possible values of
14234 @code{:eval} and their effects are shown below.
14235
14236 @table @code
14237 @item never or no
14238 The code block will not be evaluated under any circumstances.
14239 @item query
14240 Evaluation of the code block will require a query.
14241 @item never-export or no-export
14242 The code block will not be evaluated during export but may still be called
14243 interactively.
14244 @item query-export
14245 Evaluation of the code block during export will require a query.
14246 @end table
14247
14248 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
14249 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
14250 security}.
14251
14252 @node wrap, , eval, Specific header arguments
14253 @subsubsection @code{:wrap}
14254 The @code{:wrap} header argument is used to mark the results of source block
14255 evaluation. The header argument can be passed a string that will be appended
14256 to @code{#+BEGIN_} and @code{#+END_}, which will then be used to wrap the
14257 results. If not string is specified then the results will be wrapped in a
14258 @code{#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS} block.
14259
14260 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
14261 @section Results of evaluation
14262 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
14263 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
14264
14265 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
14266 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
14267 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
14268 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
14269
14270 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
14271 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
14272 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
14273 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
14274 @end multitable
14275
14276 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
14277 non-session is returned to Org mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
14278 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
14279
14280 @subsection Non-session
14281 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14282 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
14283 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
14284 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
14285 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
14286 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
14287 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
14288
14289 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
14290 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
14291
14292 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14293 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
14294 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
14295 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
14296 future work.)
14297
14298 @subsection Session
14299 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
14300 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
14301 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
14302 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
14303 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
14304 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
14305 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
14306 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
14307
14308 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
14309 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
14310 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
14311 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
14312 in R).
14313
14314 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
14315 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
14316 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
14317 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
14318 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
14319 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
14320 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
14321
14322 @example
14323 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output
14324 print "hello"
14325 2
14326 print "bye"
14327 #+END_SRC
14328
14329 #+RESULTS:
14330 : hello
14331 : bye
14332 @end example
14333
14334 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
14335
14336 @example
14337 #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session
14338 print "hello"
14339 2
14340 print "bye"
14341 #+END_SRC
14342
14343 #+RESULTS:
14344 : hello
14345 : 2
14346 : bye
14347 @end example
14348
14349 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
14350 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
14351 unnecessary here).
14352
14353 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
14354 @section Noweb reference syntax
14355 @cindex code block, noweb reference
14356 @cindex syntax, noweb
14357 @cindex source code, noweb reference
14358
14359 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
14360 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
14361 familiar Noweb syntax:
14362
14363 @example
14364 <<code-block-name>>
14365 @end example
14366
14367 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
14368 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
14369 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
14370 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
14371 expanded before evaluation. See the @ref{noweb-ref} header argument for
14372 a more flexible way to resolve noweb references.
14373
14374 It is possible to include the @emph{results} of a code block rather than the
14375 body. This is done by appending parenthesis to the code block name which may
14376 optionally contain arguments to the code block as shown below.
14377
14378 @example
14379 <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>>
14380 @end example
14381
14382 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
14383 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
14384 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
14385 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
14386 the default value.
14387
14388 Note: if noweb tangling is slow in large Org mode files consider setting the
14389 @code{*org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion*} variable to true.
14390 This will result in faster noweb reference resolution at the expense of not
14391 correctly resolving inherited values of the @code{:noweb-ref} header
14392 argument.
14393
14394 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
14395 @section Key bindings and useful functions
14396 @cindex code block, key bindings
14397
14398 Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
14399 the context.
14400
14401 Within a code block, the following key bindings
14402 are active:
14403
14404 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14405 @kindex C-c C-c
14406 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
14407 @kindex C-c C-o
14408 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14409 @kindex C-up
14410 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14411 @kindex M-down
14412 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
14413 @end multitable
14414
14415 In an Org mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
14416
14417 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
14418 @kindex C-c C-v p
14419 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
14420 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-previous-src-block}
14421 @kindex C-c C-v n
14422 @kindex C-c C-v C-n
14423 @item @kbd{C-c C-v n} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-n} @tab @code{org-babel-next-src-block}
14424 @kindex C-c C-v e
14425 @kindex C-c C-v C-e
14426 @item @kbd{C-c C-v e} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-e} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-maybe}
14427 @kindex C-c C-v o
14428 @kindex C-c C-v C-o
14429 @item @kbd{C-c C-v o} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
14430 @kindex C-c C-v v
14431 @kindex C-c C-v C-v
14432 @item @kbd{C-c C-v v} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-v} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14433 @kindex C-c C-v u
14434 @kindex C-c C-v C-u
14435 @item @kbd{C-c C-v u} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-u} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-src-block-head}
14436 @kindex C-c C-v g
14437 @kindex C-c C-v C-g
14438 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-src-block}
14439 @kindex C-c C-v r
14440 @kindex C-c C-v C-r
14441 @item @kbd{C-c C-v r} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-r} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-result}
14442 @kindex C-c C-v b
14443 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
14444 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14445 @kindex C-c C-v s
14446 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
14447 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14448 @kindex C-c C-v d
14449 @kindex C-c C-v C-d
14450 @item @kbd{C-c C-v d} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-d} @tab @code{org-babel-demarcate-block}
14451 @kindex C-c C-v t
14452 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
14453 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14454 @kindex C-c C-v f
14455 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
14456 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14457 @kindex C-c C-v c
14458 @kindex C-c C-v C-c
14459 @item @kbd{C-c C-v c} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-check-src-block}
14460 @kindex C-c C-v j
14461 @kindex C-c C-v C-j
14462 @item @kbd{C-c C-v j} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-j} @tab @code{org-babel-insert-header-arg}
14463 @kindex C-c C-v l
14464 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
14465 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
14466 @kindex C-c C-v i
14467 @kindex C-c C-v C-i
14468 @item @kbd{C-c C-v i} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-i} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14469 @kindex C-c C-v I
14470 @kindex C-c C-v C-I
14471 @item @kbd{C-c C-v I} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-I} @tab @code{org-babel-view-src-block-info}
14472 @kindex C-c C-v z
14473 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
14474 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code}
14475 @kindex C-c C-v a
14476 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
14477 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14478 @kindex C-c C-v h
14479 @kindex C-c C-v C-h
14480 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
14481 @kindex C-c C-v x
14482 @kindex C-c C-v C-x
14483 @item @kbd{C-c C-v x} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-x} @tab @code{org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer}
14484 @end multitable
14485
14486 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
14487 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
14488
14489 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
14490 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
14491 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
14492 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
14493 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
14494 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
14495 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
14496 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
14497 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
14498 @c @end multitable
14499
14500 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
14501 @section Batch execution
14502 @cindex code block, batch execution
14503 @cindex source code, batch execution
14504
14505 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
14506 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
14507
14508 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
14509
14510 @example
14511 #!/bin/sh
14512 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
14513 #
14514 # tangle files with org-mode
14515 #
14516 DIR=`pwd`
14517 FILES=""
14518
14519 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
14520 for i in $@@; do
14521 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
14522 done
14523
14524 emacs -Q --batch \
14525 --eval "(progn
14526 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
14527 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\" t))
14528 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
14529 (mapc (lambda (file)
14530 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
14531 (org-babel-tangle)
14532 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
14533 @end example
14534
14535 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
14536 @chapter Miscellaneous
14537
14538 @menu
14539 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
14540 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
14541 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
14542 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
14543 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
14544 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
14545 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
14546 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
14547 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
14548 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
14549 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
14550 @end menu
14551
14552
14553 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
14554 @section Completion
14555 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
14556 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
14557 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
14558 @cindex completion, of option keywords
14559 @cindex completion, of tags
14560 @cindex completion, of property keys
14561 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
14562 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
14563 @cindex TODO keywords completion
14564 @cindex dictionary word completion
14565 @cindex option keyword completion
14566 @cindex tag completion
14567 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
14568
14569 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org mode uses it whenever it
14570 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
14571 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
14572 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
14573 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
14574
14575 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
14576 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
14577 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
14578
14579 @table @kbd
14580 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
14581 @item M-@key{TAB}
14582 Complete word at point
14583 @itemize @bullet
14584 @item
14585 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
14586 @item
14587 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
14588 @item
14589 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
14590 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
14591 @item
14592 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
14593 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
14594 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
14595 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
14596 @item
14597 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
14598 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
14599 buffer.
14600 @item
14601 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
14602 @item
14603 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
14604 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
14605 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
14606 will insert example settings for this keyword.
14607 @item
14608 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
14609 i.e., valid keys for this line.
14610 @item
14611 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
14612 @end itemize
14613 @end table
14614
14615 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
14616 @section Easy Templates
14617 @cindex template insertion
14618 @cindex insertion, of templates
14619
14620 Org mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
14621 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
14622 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
14623 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
14624 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
14625
14626 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
14627 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
14628 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
14629
14630 The following template selectors are currently supported.
14631
14632 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
14633 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC}
14634 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE}
14635 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE}
14636 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE}
14637 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER}
14638 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_LaTeX ... #+END_LaTeX}
14639 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+LaTeX:}
14640 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_HTML ... #+END_HTML}
14641 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+HTML:}
14642 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+BEGIN_ASCII ... #+END_ASCII}
14643 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ASCII:}
14644 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+INDEX:} line
14645 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+INCLUDE:} line
14646 @end multitable
14647
14648 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
14649 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
14650
14651 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
14652 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
14653 additional details.
14654
14655 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
14656 @section Speed keys
14657 @cindex speed keys
14658 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
14659 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
14660
14661 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
14662 beginning of a headline, i.e., before the first star. Configure the variable
14663 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
14664 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
14665 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
14666 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
14667 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
14668 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
14669
14670 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
14671 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
14672
14673 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
14674 @section Code evaluation and security issues
14675
14676 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
14677
14678 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
14679 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
14680 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
14681 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
14682 these precautions intact.
14683
14684 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
14685 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
14686 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
14687
14688 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
14689
14690 @table @i
14691 @item Source code blocks
14692 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
14693 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
14694 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
14695 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
14696 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
14697
14698 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
14699 which take off the default security brakes.
14700
14701 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
14702 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
14703 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
14704 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
14705 ask and nil not to ask.
14706 @end defopt
14707
14708 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
14709 without asking:
14710
14711 @example
14712 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
14713 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
14714 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
14715 @end example
14716
14717 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
14718 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
14719 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
14720 not visible.
14721
14722 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
14723 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
14724 @end defopt
14725 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
14726 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
14727 @end defopt
14728
14729 @item Formulas in tables
14730 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
14731 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
14732 @end table
14733
14734 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
14735 @section Customization
14736 @cindex customization
14737 @cindex options, for customization
14738 @cindex variables, for customization
14739
14740 There are more than 500 variables that can be used to customize
14741 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
14742 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
14743 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
14744 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
14745 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
14746 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
14747
14748 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
14749 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
14750 @cindex in-buffer settings
14751 @cindex special keywords
14752
14753 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
14754 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
14755 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
14756 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
14757 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
14758 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
14759 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
14760 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
14761 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
14762
14763 @vindex org-archive-location
14764 @table @kbd
14765 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
14766 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
14767 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
14768 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14769 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
14770 @item #+CATEGORY:
14771 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
14772 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
14773 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
14774 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
14775 @cindex property, COLUMNS
14776 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
14777 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
14778 applies.
14779 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
14780 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
14781 @vindex org-table-formula
14782 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
14783 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
14784 The global version of this variable is
14785 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
14786 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
14787 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
14788 top-level entries.
14789 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
14790 @vindex org-drawers
14791 Set the file-local set of additional drawers. The corresponding global
14792 variable is @code{org-drawers}.
14793 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
14794 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
14795 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
14796 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
14797 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
14798 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
14799 @vindex org-highest-priority
14800 @vindex org-lowest-priority
14801 @vindex org-default-priority
14802 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
14803 must be either letters A--Z or numbers 0--9. The highest priority must
14804 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
14805 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
14806 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
14807 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
14808 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
14809 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
14810 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
14811 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
14812 (i.e., when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
14813 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
14814 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
14815 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
14816 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
14817 @item #+STARTUP:
14818 @cindex #+STARTUP:
14819 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
14820 Org file is being visited.
14821
14822 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
14823 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
14824 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
14825 @code{overview}.
14826 @vindex org-startup-folded
14827 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
14828 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
14829 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
14830 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
14831 @example
14832 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
14833 content @r{all headlines}
14834 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
14835 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
14836 @end example
14837
14838 @vindex org-startup-indented
14839 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
14840 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
14841 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
14842 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org mode 6.29 are required}
14843 @example
14844 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
14845 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
14846 @end example
14847
14848 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
14849 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
14850 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
14851 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
14852 @code{nil}.
14853 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
14854 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
14855 @example
14856 align @r{align all tables}
14857 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
14858 @end example
14859
14860 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
14861 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
14862 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
14863 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
14864 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14865 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
14866 @example
14867 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
14868 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
14869 @end example
14870
14871 @vindex org-log-done
14872 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
14873 @vindex org-log-repeat
14874 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
14875 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
14876 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
14877 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
14878 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
14879 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
14880 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14881 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
14882 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14883 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14884 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
14885 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14886 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14887 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
14888 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14889 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14890 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
14891 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14892 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
14893 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
14894 @example
14895 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
14896 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
14897 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
14898 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
14899 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
14900 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
14901 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
14902 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
14903 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
14904 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
14905 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
14906 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
14907 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
14908 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
14909 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
14910 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
14911 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
14912 @end example
14913 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
14914 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14915 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
14916 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
14917 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
14918 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
14919 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
14920 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
14921 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
14922 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
14923 @example
14924 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
14925 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
14926 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
14927 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
14928 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
14929 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
14930 @end example
14931 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
14932 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
14933 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
14934 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
14935 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
14936 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
14937 @example
14938 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
14939 @end example
14940 @vindex constants-unit-system
14941 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
14942 @code{constants-unit-system}).
14943 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
14944 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
14945 @example
14946 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
14947 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
14948 @end example
14949 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
14950 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
14951 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
14952 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
14953 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
14954 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
14955 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
14956 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
14957 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
14958 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
14959 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
14960 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
14961 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
14962 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14963 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
14964 @example
14965 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
14966 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
14967 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
14968 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
14969 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
14970 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
14971 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
14972 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
14973 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
14974 @end example
14975 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
14976 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
14977 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
14978 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14979 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
14980 @example
14981 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
14982 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
14983 @end example
14984 @cindex org-pretty-entities
14985 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
14986 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
14987 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
14988 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
14989 @example
14990 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
14991 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
14992 @end example
14993 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
14994 @vindex org-tag-alist
14995 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
14996 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
14997 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
14998 @item #+TBLFM:
14999 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
15000 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
15001 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
15002 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
15003 @itemx #+LaTeX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
15004 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
15005 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
15006 @ref{Export options}.
15007 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
15008 @vindex org-todo-keywords
15009 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
15010 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
15011 @end table
15012
15013 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
15014 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
15015 @kindex C-c C-c
15016 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
15017
15018 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
15019 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
15020 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
15021 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
15022 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
15023 what this means in different contexts.
15024
15025 @itemize @minus
15026 @item
15027 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
15028 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
15029 @item
15030 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
15031 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
15032 information.
15033 @item
15034 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
15035 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
15036 @item
15037 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
15038 the entire table.
15039 @item
15040 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
15041 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
15042 default location.
15043 @item
15044 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
15045 corresponding links in this buffer.
15046 @item
15047 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
15048 drawer, offer property commands.
15049 @item
15050 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
15051 definition, and vice versa.
15052 @item
15053 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
15054 @item
15055 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
15056 of the checkbox.
15057 @item
15058 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
15059 ordered list.
15060 @item
15061 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
15062 block is updated.
15063 @item
15064 If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp.
15065 @end itemize
15066
15067 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
15068 @section A cleaner outline view
15069 @cindex hiding leading stars
15070 @cindex dynamic indentation
15071 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
15072 @cindex clean outline view
15073
15074 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
15075 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
15076 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
15077 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
15078 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
15079
15080 @example
15081 @group
15082 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
15083 ** Second level | * Second level
15084 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15085 some text | some text
15086 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
15087 more text | more text
15088 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
15089 @end group
15090 @end example
15091
15092 @noindent
15093
15094 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
15095 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
15096 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
15097 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
15098 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
15099 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
15100 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
15101 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
15102 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
15103 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
15104 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
15105 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
15106 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
15107 @code{nil}.}; see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
15108 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
15109 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
15110 individual files using
15111
15112 @example
15113 #+STARTUP: indent
15114 @end example
15115
15116 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
15117 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
15118 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
15119 the following way:
15120
15121 @enumerate
15122 @item
15123 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
15124 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
15125 with the headline, like
15126
15127 @example
15128 *** 3rd level
15129 more text, now indented
15130 @end example
15131
15132 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
15133 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
15134 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
15135 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
15136
15137 @item
15138 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
15139 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
15140 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
15141 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
15142 with
15143
15144 @example
15145 #+STARTUP: hidestars
15146 #+STARTUP: showstars
15147 @end example
15148
15149 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
15150
15151 @example
15152 @group
15153 * Top level headline
15154 * Second level
15155 * 3rd level
15156 ...
15157 @end group
15158 @end example
15159
15160 @noindent
15161 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
15162 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
15163 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
15164 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
15165 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
15166 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
15167 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
15168
15169 @item
15170 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
15171 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
15172 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
15173 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
15174 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc.}. In this
15175 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
15176 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
15177 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
15178 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
15179
15180 @example
15181 #+STARTUP: odd
15182 #+STARTUP: oddeven
15183 @end example
15184
15185 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
15186 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
15187 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
15188 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
15189 @end enumerate
15190
15191 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
15192 @section Using Org on a tty
15193 @cindex tty key bindings
15194
15195 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
15196 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
15197 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
15198 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
15199 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
15200 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
15201 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
15202 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
15203 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
15204 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
15205 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
15206
15207 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
15208 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
15209 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
15210 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
15211 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
15212 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
15213 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
15214 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
15215 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
15216 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
15217 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
15218 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15219 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
15220 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15221 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15222 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15223 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15224 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15225 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15226 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
15227 @end multitable
15228
15229
15230 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
15231 @section Interaction with other packages
15232 @cindex packages, interaction with other
15233 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
15234 with other code out there.
15235
15236 @menu
15237 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
15238 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
15239 @end menu
15240
15241 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
15242 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
15243
15244 @table @asis
15245 @cindex @file{calc.el}
15246 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
15247 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
15248 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
15249 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
15250 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
15251 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
15252 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
15253 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
15254 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
15255 , Embedded Mode, calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
15256 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
15257 @cindex @file{constants.el}
15258 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15259 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
15260 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
15261 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
15262 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
15263 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
15264 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
15265 @samp{Mega}, etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
15266 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
15267 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
15268 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
15269 @file{constants.el}.
15270 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
15271 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
15272 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
15273 Org mode can make use of the CD@LaTeX{} package to efficiently enter
15274 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
15275 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
15276 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
15277 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
15278 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
15279 @lisp
15280 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15281 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
15282 @end lisp
15283 @vindex org-imenu-depth
15284 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
15285 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
15286 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
15287 @cindex @file{remember.el}
15288 @cindex Wiegley, John
15289 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
15290 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
15291 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
15292 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
15293 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
15294 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
15295 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
15296 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
15297 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
15298 @cindex @file{table.el}
15299 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
15300 @kindex C-c C-c
15301 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
15302 @cindex @file{table.el}
15303 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
15304
15305 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
15306 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
15307 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
15308 Org mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
15309 interference with other Org mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
15310 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
15311 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
15312
15313 @table @kbd
15314 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
15315 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
15316 @c
15317 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
15318 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
15319 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org mode
15320 format. See the documentation string of the command
15321 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
15322 possible.
15323 @end table
15324 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
15325 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
15326 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
15327 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
15328 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
15329 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
15330 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
15331 @end table
15332
15333 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
15334 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
15335
15336 @table @asis
15337
15338 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
15339 @vindex org-support-shift-select
15340 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
15341 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
15342 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
15343 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
15344 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
15345 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
15346 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
15347 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
15348 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
15349 cursor moves across a special context.
15350
15351 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
15352 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
15353 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
15354 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
15355 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
15356 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
15357 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
15358 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
15359 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
15360 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
15361 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
15362 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
15363 buffer (but not during date selection).
15364
15365 @example
15366 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
15367 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
15368 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
15369 @end example
15370
15371 @vindex org-disputed-keys
15372 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
15373 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
15374 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
15375
15376 @item @file{filladapt.el} by Kyle Jones
15377 @cindex @file{filladapt.el}
15378
15379 Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list items and
15380 other elements. Many users reported they had problems using both
15381 @file{filladapt.el} and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable it like
15382 this:
15383
15384 @lisp
15385 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode)
15386 @end lisp
15387
15388 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
15389 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
15390 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
15391 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
15392 fixed this problem:
15393
15394 @lisp
15395 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15396 (lambda ()
15397 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
15398 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand)))
15399 @end lisp
15400
15401 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
15402 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
15403 function:
15404
15405 @lisp
15406 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
15407 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
15408 @end lisp
15409
15410 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
15411
15412 @lisp
15413 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
15414 (lambda ()
15415 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
15416 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
15417 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
15418 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
15419 @end lisp
15420
15421 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
15422 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
15423 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
15424 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
15425 the windmove function active in locations where Org mode does not have
15426 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
15427 configuration:
15428
15429 @lisp
15430 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
15431 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
15432 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
15433 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
15434 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
15435 @end lisp
15436
15437 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
15438 @cindex @file{viper.el}
15439 @kindex C-c /
15440 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
15441 corresponding Org mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
15442 another key for this command, or override the key in
15443 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
15444
15445 @lisp
15446 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
15447 @end lisp
15448
15449 @end table
15450
15451 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
15452 @section org-crypt.el
15453 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
15454 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
15455
15456 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
15457 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
15458 files.
15459
15460 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
15461 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
15462 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
15463
15464 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
15465 @file{.emacs}:
15466
15467 @example
15468 (require 'org-crypt)
15469 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
15470 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
15471
15472 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
15473 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
15474 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
15475
15476 (setq auto-save-default nil)
15477 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
15478 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
15479 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
15480 ;; start Org.
15481
15482 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
15483 ;;
15484 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
15485 @end example
15486
15487 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
15488 being encrypted again.
15489
15490 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
15491 @appendix Hacking
15492 @cindex hacking
15493
15494 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
15495 Org.
15496
15497 @menu
15498 * Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals
15499 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
15500 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
15501 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
15502 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
15503 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
15504 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
15505 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
15506 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
15507 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
15508 @end menu
15509
15510 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
15511 @section Hooks
15512 @cindex hooks
15513
15514 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
15515 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
15516 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
15517 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
15518 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
15519
15520 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
15521 @section Add-on packages
15522 @cindex add-on packages
15523
15524 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
15525 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
15526 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
15527 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
15528 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
15529 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
15530
15531
15532
15533 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
15534 @section Adding hyperlink types
15535 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
15536
15537 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
15538 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
15539 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
15540 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
15541 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
15542 Emacs:
15543
15544 @lisp
15545 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
15546
15547 (require 'org)
15548
15549 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
15550 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
15551
15552 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
15553 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
15554 :group 'org-link
15555 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
15556
15557 (defun org-man-open (path)
15558 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
15559 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
15560 (funcall org-man-command path))
15561
15562 (defun org-man-store-link ()
15563 "Store a link to a manpage."
15564 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
15565 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
15566 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
15567 (link (concat "man:" page))
15568 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
15569 (org-store-link-props
15570 :type "man"
15571 :link link
15572 :description description))))
15573
15574 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
15575 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
15576 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
15577 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
15578 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
15579 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
15580
15581 (provide 'org-man)
15582
15583 ;;; org-man.el ends here
15584 @end lisp
15585
15586 @noindent
15587 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
15588
15589 @lisp
15590 (require 'org-man)
15591 @end lisp
15592
15593 @noindent
15594 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
15595 @enumerate
15596 @item
15597 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
15598 loaded.
15599 @item
15600 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
15601 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
15602 that will be called to follow such a link.
15603 @item
15604 @vindex org-store-link-functions
15605 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
15606 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
15607 buffer displaying a man page.
15608 @end enumerate
15609
15610 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
15611 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
15612 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
15613 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
15614 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
15615 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
15616 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
15617
15618 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
15619 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
15620 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
15621 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
15622 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
15623 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
15624 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
15625 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
15626 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
15627 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
15628 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
15629 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
15630
15631 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
15632 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g., completion)
15633 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
15634 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
15635
15636 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
15637 @section Context-sensitive commands
15638 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
15639 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
15640 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
15641
15642 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
15643 important example is the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
15644 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
15645
15646 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
15647 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
15648 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
15649 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
15650 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the Org mode functionality
15651 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
15652 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
15653 @code{#+RR:}.
15654
15655 @lisp
15656 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
15657 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
15658 (if (save-excursion
15659 (beginning-of-line 1)
15660 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
15661 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
15662 t) ;; to signal that we took action
15663 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
15664
15665 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
15666 @end lisp
15667
15668 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
15669 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
15670 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
15671 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
15672 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
15673
15674
15675 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
15676 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
15677 @cindex tables, in other modes
15678 @cindex lists, in other modes
15679 @cindex Orgtbl mode
15680
15681 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
15682 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
15683 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
15684 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
15685 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
15686 editor.
15687
15688 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
15689 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
15690 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
15691 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
15692 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
15693 for a very flexible system.
15694
15695 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
15696 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
15697 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
15698 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
15699
15700
15701 @menu
15702 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
15703 * A @LaTeX{} example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
15704 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
15705 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
15706 @end menu
15707
15708 @node Radio tables, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15709 @subsection Radio tables
15710 @cindex radio tables
15711
15712 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
15713 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
15714 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
15715 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
15716
15717 @example
15718 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15719 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
15720 @end example
15721
15722 @noindent
15723 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
15724 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
15725 example:
15726 @cindex #+ORGTBL
15727 @example
15728 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
15729 @end example
15730
15731 @noindent
15732 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
15733 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
15734 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
15735 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
15736 passed as a property list to the translation function for
15737 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
15738 acted upon before the translation function is called:
15739
15740 @table @code
15741 @item :skip N
15742 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
15743 this parameter!
15744
15745 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
15746 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
15747 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
15748 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
15749 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
15750 additional columns.
15751
15752 @item :no-escape t
15753 When non-nil, do not escape special characters @code{&%#_^} when exporting
15754 the table. The default value is nil.
15755 @end table
15756
15757 @noindent
15758 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
15759 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
15760 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
15761 number of different solutions:
15762
15763 @itemize @bullet
15764 @item
15765 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
15766 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
15767 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
15768 @item
15769 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
15770 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
15771 in @LaTeX{}.
15772 @item
15773 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
15774 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
15775 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
15776 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
15777 key.
15778 @end itemize
15779
15780 @node A @LaTeX{} example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15781 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
15782 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
15783
15784 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
15785 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
15786 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
15787 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
15788 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
15789 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
15790 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
15791 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
15792 will then get the following template:
15793
15794 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
15795 @example
15796 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15797 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15798 \begin@{comment@}
15799 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15800 | | |
15801 \end@{comment@}
15802 @end example
15803
15804 @noindent
15805 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
15806 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
15807 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
15808 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
15809 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
15810 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
15811 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
15812 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
15813 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
15814 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
15815 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
15816 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
15817
15818 @example
15819 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15820 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15821 \begin@{comment@}
15822 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
15823 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15824 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15825 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15826 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15827 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15828 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15829 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
15830 \end@{comment@}
15831 @end example
15832
15833 @noindent
15834 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
15835 table inserted between the two marker lines.
15836
15837 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
15838 want to control how columns are aligned, etc. In this case we make sure
15839 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
15840 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e., to not produce
15841 header and footer commands of the target table:
15842
15843 @example
15844 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
15845 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
15846 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15847 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
15848 \end@{tabular@}
15849 %
15850 \begin@{comment@}
15851 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
15852 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
15853 |-------+------+---------+---------|
15854 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
15855 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
15856 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
15857 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
15858 \end@{comment@}
15859 @end example
15860
15861 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
15862 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
15863 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
15864 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
15865
15866 @table @code
15867 @item :splice nil/t
15868 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
15869 tabular environment. Default is nil.
15870
15871 @item :fmt fmt
15872 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
15873 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
15874 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
15875 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
15876 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
15877 function must return a formatted string.
15878
15879 @item :efmt efmt
15880 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
15881 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
15882 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
15883 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
15884 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
15885 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
15886 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
15887 supplied instead of strings.
15888 @end table
15889
15890 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A @LaTeX{} example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15891 @subsection Translator functions
15892 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
15893 @cindex translator function
15894
15895 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
15896 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
15897 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
15898 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
15899 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
15900 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
15901 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
15902 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
15903 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
15904
15905 @lisp
15906 @group
15907 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
15908 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
15909 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
15910 org-table-last-alignment ""))
15911 (params2
15912 (list
15913 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
15914 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
15915 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
15916 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
15917 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
15918 @end group
15919 @end lisp
15920
15921 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
15922 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
15923 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e., the
15924 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
15925 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
15926 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
15927 overrule the default with
15928
15929 @example
15930 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
15931 @end example
15932
15933 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
15934 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
15935 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
15936 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
15937 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
15938 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
15939 a single line!):
15940
15941 @example
15942 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
15943 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
15944 @end example
15945
15946 @noindent
15947 Please check the documentation string of the function
15948 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
15949 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
15950 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
15951 using the generic function.
15952
15953 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
15954 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
15955 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
15956 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
15957 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
15958 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
15959 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
15960 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
15961 others can benefit from your work.
15962
15963 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
15964 @subsection Radio lists
15965 @cindex radio lists
15966 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
15967
15968 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
15969 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
15970 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
15971 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
15972
15973 Here are the differences with radio tables:
15974
15975 @itemize @minus
15976 @item
15977 Orgstruct mode must be active.
15978 @item
15979 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
15980 @item
15981 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
15982 parameters.
15983 @item
15984 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
15985 @end itemize
15986
15987 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
15988 @LaTeX{} file:
15989
15990 @cindex #+ORGLST
15991 @example
15992 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15993 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
15994 \begin@{comment@}
15995 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
15996 - a new house
15997 - a new computer
15998 + a new keyboard
15999 + a new mouse
16000 - a new life
16001 \end@{comment@}
16002 @end example
16003
16004 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
16005 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
16006
16007 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
16008 @section Dynamic blocks
16009 @cindex dynamic blocks
16010
16011 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
16012 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
16013 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
16014 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
16015
16016 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
16017 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
16018 the content of the block.
16019
16020 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
16021 @example
16022 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
16023
16024 #+END:
16025 @end example
16026
16027 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
16028
16029 @table @kbd
16030 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
16031 Update dynamic block at point.
16032 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
16033 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
16034 @end table
16035
16036 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
16037 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
16038 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
16039 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
16040 extra parameter @code{:content}.
16041
16042 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
16043 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
16044 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
16045 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
16046 run:
16047
16048 @example
16049 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
16050
16051 #+END:
16052 @end example
16053
16054 @noindent
16055 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
16056
16057 @lisp
16058 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
16059 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
16060 (insert "Last block update at: "
16061 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
16062 @end lisp
16063
16064 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
16065 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
16066 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
16067 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
16068 @code{org-mode}.
16069
16070 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
16071 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
16072
16073 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
16074 @section Special agenda views
16075 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
16076
16077 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16078 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
16079 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
16080 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
16081 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
16082 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
16083 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
16084 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
16085 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
16086 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
16087 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
16088
16089 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
16090 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
16091 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
16092 PROJECT@. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
16093 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
16094 the subtree belonging to the project line.
16095
16096 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
16097 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
16098 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
16099 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
16100 search should continue from there.
16101
16102 @lisp
16103 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
16104 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
16105 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
16106 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
16107 nil ; tag found, do not skip
16108 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
16109 @end lisp
16110
16111 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
16112 like this:
16113
16114 @lisp
16115 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16116 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16117 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
16118 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16119 @end lisp
16120
16121 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
16122 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
16123 meaningful header in the agenda view.
16124
16125 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
16126 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16127 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
16128 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
16129 your custom search function, simply do a search for
16130 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
16131 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
16132 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
16133 you really want to have.
16134
16135 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
16136 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
16137 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
16138
16139 @table @code
16140 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
16141 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
16142 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
16143 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
16144 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
16145 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
16146 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
16147 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
16148 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
16149 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
16150 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
16151 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
16152 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
16153 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
16154 @anchor{x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp}
16155 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16156 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
16157 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")
16158 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
16159 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
16160 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
16161 @end table
16162
16163 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
16164 like this, even without defining a special function:
16165
16166 @lisp
16167 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
16168 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
16169 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
16170 'regexp ":waiting:"))
16171 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
16172 @end lisp
16173
16174 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
16175 @section Extracting agenda information
16176 @cindex agenda, pipe
16177 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
16178
16179 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
16180 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
16181 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
16182 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
16183 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
16184 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
16185 ASCII text to STDOUT@. The command takes a single string as parameter.
16186 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
16187 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
16188 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
16189 current TODO list, you could use
16190
16191 @example
16192 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
16193 @end example
16194
16195 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
16196 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
16197 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
16198 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
16199
16200 @example
16201 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16202 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
16203 @end example
16204
16205 @noindent
16206 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
16207
16208 @example
16209 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
16210 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
16211 org-agenda-span (quote month) \
16212 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
16213 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
16214 | lpr
16215 @end example
16216
16217 @noindent
16218 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
16219 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
16220
16221 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
16222 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
16223 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
16224 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
16225 are:
16226
16227 @example
16228 category @r{The category of the item}
16229 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
16230 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
16231 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
16232 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
16233 diary @r{imported from diary}
16234 deadline @r{a deadline}
16235 scheduled @r{scheduled}
16236 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
16237 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
16238 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
16239 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
16240 block @r{entry has date block including date}
16241 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
16242 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
16243 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
16244 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
16245 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
16246 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
16247 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
16248 @end example
16249
16250 @noindent
16251 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
16252 led to the selection of the item.
16253
16254 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
16255 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
16256 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
16257
16258 @example
16259 #!/usr/bin/perl
16260
16261 # define the Emacs command to run
16262 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
16263
16264 # run it and capture the output
16265 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
16266
16267 # loop over all lines
16268 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
16269 # get the individual values
16270 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
16271 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
16272 # process and print
16273 print "[ ] $head\n";
16274 @}
16275 @end example
16276
16277 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
16278 @section Using the property API
16279 @cindex API, for properties
16280 @cindex properties, API
16281
16282 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
16283 properties.
16284
16285 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
16286 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
16287 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
16288 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
16289 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
16290 if the property key was used several times.@*
16291 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
16292 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
16293 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
16294 @end defun
16295 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
16296 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
16297 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
16298 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM@. By default,
16299 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
16300 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
16301 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
16302 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
16303 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
16304 @end defun
16305
16306 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
16307 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
16308 @end defun
16309
16310 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
16311 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
16312 @end defun
16313
16314 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
16315 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
16316 @end defun
16317
16318 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
16319 Insert a property drawer for the current entry. Also
16320 @end defun
16321
16322 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
16323 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES@. VALUES should be a list of
16324 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
16325 @end defun
16326
16327 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
16328 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16329 values and return the values as a list of strings.
16330 @end defun
16331
16332 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
16333 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16334 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
16335 @end defun
16336
16337 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
16338 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16339 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
16340 @end defun
16341
16342 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
16343 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
16344 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
16345 @end defun
16346
16347 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
16348 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
16349 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
16350 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
16351 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
16352 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
16353 responsible for this property.
16354 @end defopt
16355
16356 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
16357 @section Using the mapping API
16358 @cindex API, for mapping
16359 @cindex mapping entries, API
16360
16361 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
16362 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
16363 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
16364 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
16365 is:
16366
16367 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
16368 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
16369
16370 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
16371 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
16372 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
16373 returned as a list.
16374
16375 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
16376 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
16377 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
16378 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
16379 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
16380 if you have removed (e.g., archived) the current (sub)tree it could
16381 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
16382 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
16383 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
16384 position.
16385
16386 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
16387 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
16388 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
16389 visited by the iteration.
16390
16391 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
16392
16393 @example
16394 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
16395 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
16396 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
16397 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
16398 file-with-archives
16399 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
16400 agenda @r{all agenda files}
16401 agenda-with-archives
16402 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
16403 (file1 file2 ...)
16404 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
16405 @end example
16406 @noindent
16407 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
16408 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
16409
16410 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
16411 @example
16412 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
16413 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
16414 function or Lisp form
16415 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
16416 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
16417 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
16418 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
16419 @end example
16420 @end defun
16421
16422 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
16423 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
16424 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
16425 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
16426
16427 @defun org-todo &optional arg
16428 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
16429 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
16430 @end defun
16431
16432 @defun org-priority &optional action
16433 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
16434 possible values for ACTION.
16435 @end defun
16436
16437 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
16438 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
16439 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
16440 @end defun
16441
16442 @defun org-promote
16443 Promote the current entry.
16444 @end defun
16445
16446 @defun org-demote
16447 Demote the current entry.
16448 @end defun
16449
16450 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
16451 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
16452 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
16453
16454 @lisp
16455 (org-map-entries
16456 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
16457 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
16458 @end lisp
16459
16460 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
16461 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
16462
16463 @lisp
16464 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
16465 @end lisp
16466
16467 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
16468 @appendix MobileOrg
16469 @cindex iPhone
16470 @cindex MobileOrg
16471
16472 @i{MobileOrg} is the name of the mobile companion app for Org mode, currently
16473 available for iOS and for Android. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and
16474 capture support for an Org mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
16475 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries.
16476 The @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, iOS implementation} for the
16477 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad} series of devices, was developed by Richard
16478 Moreland. Android users should check out
16479 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
16480 by Matt Jones. The two implementations are not identical but offer similar
16481 features.
16482
16483 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
16484 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
16485 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
16486
16487 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
16488 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
16489 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
16490 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
16491 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
16492 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
16493 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
16494
16495 @menu
16496 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
16497 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
16498 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
16499 @end menu
16500
16501 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16502 @section Setting up the staging area
16503
16504 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
16505 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
16506 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org mode 7.02 and with
16507 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
16508 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
16509 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
16510 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
16511 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
16512 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
16513 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
16514 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
16515
16516 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
16517 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
16518 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
16519 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
16520 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
16521 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
16522 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
16523 Emacs about it:
16524
16525 @lisp
16526 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
16527 @end lisp
16528
16529 Org mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
16530 and to read captured notes from there.
16531
16532 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
16533 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
16534
16535 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
16536 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
16537 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
16538 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
16539 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
16540 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
16541 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
16542 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties
16543 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
16544 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
16545 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
16546 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
16547 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
16548 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
16549 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
16550 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
16551 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{Checksums are stored
16552 automatically in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
16553
16554 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
16555 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
16556
16557 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
16558 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
16559 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
16560 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
16561 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
16562
16563 @enumerate
16564 @item
16565 Org moves all entries found in
16566 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
16567 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
16568 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
16569 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
16570 @item
16571 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
16572 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
16573 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
16574 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
16575 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
16576 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
16577 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
16578 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
16579 @item
16580 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
16581 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
16582 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
16583 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
16584 agenda line.
16585 @table @kbd
16586 @kindex ?
16587 @item ?
16588 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
16589 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
16590 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
16591 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
16592 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
16593 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
16594 this flagged entry is finished.
16595 @end table
16596 @end enumerate
16597
16598 @kindex C-c a ?
16599 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
16600 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
16601 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
16602 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
16603 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
16604 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
16605 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
16606
16607 @node History and Acknowledgments, GNU Free Documentation License, MobileOrg, Top
16608 @appendix History and acknowledgments
16609 @cindex acknowledgments
16610 @cindex history
16611 @cindex thanks
16612
16613 @section From Carsten
16614
16615 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
16616 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
16617 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
16618 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
16619 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
16620 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
16621 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
16622 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
16623 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
16624 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
16625 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
16626 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
16627 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
16628 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
16629 functionality directly into a notes file.
16630
16631 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
16632 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
16633 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
16634 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
16635 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
16636 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
16637 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
16638 let me know.
16639
16640 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
16641
16642 @table @i
16643 @item Bastien Guerry
16644 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
16645 integrated into the core by now), including the @LaTeX{} exporter and the plain
16646 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
16647 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
16648 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsored
16649 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
16650 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
16651 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
16652 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
16653 programming and reproducible research.
16654 @item John Wiegley
16655 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
16656 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
16657 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
16658 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
16659 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
16660 of his great @file{remember.el}.
16661 @item Sebastian Rose
16662 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
16663 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
16664 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
16665 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
16666 single-key navigation.
16667 @end table
16668
16669 @noindent See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please
16670 let me know what I am missing here!
16671
16672 @section From Bastien
16673
16674 I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org since January 2011. This appendix
16675 would not be complete without adding a few more acknowledgements and thanks
16676 to Carsten's ones above.
16677
16678 I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over the
16679 maintainership of Org. His support as been great since day one of this new
16680 adventure, and it helped a lot.
16681
16682 When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more
16683 collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more
16684 knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of the
16685 persons I could rely on, they should really be considered co-maintainers,
16686 either of the code or the community:
16687
16688 @table @i
16689 @item Eric Schulte
16690 Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here kept me away
16691 from worrying about possible bugs here and let me focus on other parts.
16692
16693 @item Nicolas Goaziou
16694 Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of Org. His work
16695 on @file{org-element.el} and @file{org-export.el} has been outstanding, and
16696 opened the doors for many new ideas and features.
16697
16698 @item Jambunathan K
16699 Jambunathan contributed the ODT exporter, definitely a killer feature of
16700 Org mode. He also contributed the new HTML exporter, which is another core
16701 feature of Org. Here too, I knew I could rely on him to fix bugs in these
16702 areas and to patiently explain the users what was the problems and solutions.
16703
16704 @item Achim Gratz
16705 Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some @emph{ad hoc} tools
16706 into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He patiently coped with the
16707 many hiccups that such a change can create for users.
16708
16709 @item Nick Dokos
16710 The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without Nick, who
16711 patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible to overestimate such
16712 a great help, and the list would not be so active without him.
16713 @end table
16714
16715 I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible to be
16716 fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not be
16717 complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual.
16718
16719 @section List of contributions
16720
16721 @itemize @bullet
16722
16723 @item
16724 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
16725 @item
16726 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
16727 @item
16728 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
16729 Org mode website.
16730 @item
16731 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
16732 @item
16733 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
16734 @item
16735 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files.
16736 @item
16737 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
16738 @item
16739 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
16740 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
16741 @item
16742 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
16743 specified time.
16744 @item
16745 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
16746 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
16747 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
16748 @item
16749 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
16750 @item
16751 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
16752 @item
16753 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
16754 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
16755 them.
16756 @item
16757 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
16758 @item
16759 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
16760 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
16761 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
16762 @item
16763 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
16764 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
16765 @item
16766 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
16767 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
16768 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
16769 @item
16770 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
16771 HTML agendas.
16772 @item
16773 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
16774 @item
16775 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
16776 @item
16777 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
16778 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
16779 @item
16780 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
16781 @item
16782 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
16783 @item
16784 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
16785 @item
16786 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
16787 testing.
16788 @item
16789 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
16790 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
16791 @item
16792 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
16793 @item
16794 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
16795 @item
16796 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
16797 @item
16798 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
16799 book.
16800 @item
16801 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
16802 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
16803 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
16804 @item
16805 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
16806 patches.
16807 @item
16808 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
16809 @item
16810 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
16811 folded entries, and column view for properties.
16812 @item
16813 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
16814 @item
16815 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
16816 @item
16817 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
16818 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
16819 @item
16820 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
16821 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
16822 @item
16823 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
16824 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
16825 small fixes and patches.
16826 @item
16827 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
16828 @item
16829 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
16830 @item
16831 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
16832 basis.
16833 @item
16834 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
16835 happy.
16836 @item
16837 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
16838 @item
16839 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
16840 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
16841 @item
16842 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
16843 @item
16844 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
16845 @item
16846 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
16847 file links, and TAGS.
16848 @item
16849 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
16850 version of the reference card.
16851 @item
16852 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
16853 into Japanese.
16854 @item
16855 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
16856 @item
16857 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
16858 links, among other things.
16859 @item
16860 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
16861 provided frequent feedback.
16862 @item
16863 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
16864 into bundles of 20 for undo.
16865 @item
16866 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
16867 @item
16868 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
16869 control.
16870 @item
16871 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
16872 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
16873 @item
16874 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
16875 @item
16876 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
16877 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
16878 @item
16879 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
16880 extensive patches.
16881 @item
16882 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
16883 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
16884 @item
16885 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
16886 other things.
16887 @item
16888 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
16889 @item
16890 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
16891 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
16892 @item
16893 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
16894 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
16895 @item
16896 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
16897 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
16898 @item
16899 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
16900 subtrees.
16901 @item
16902 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
16903 @item
16904 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
16905 tweaks and features.
16906 @item
16907 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
16908 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
16909 @item
16910 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
16911 @LaTeX{}, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
16912 @item
16913 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
16914 with links transformation to Org syntax.
16915 @item
16916 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
16917 chapter about publishing.
16918 @item
16919 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the ODT exporter.
16920 @item
16921 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with @LaTeX{} and BEAMER export and
16922 enabled source code highlighting in Gnus.
16923 @item
16924 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
16925 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
16926 concept index for HTML export.
16927 @item
16928 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
16929 in HTML output.
16930 @item
16931 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
16932 @item
16933 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
16934 keyword.
16935 @item
16936 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
16937 system.
16938 @item
16939 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
16940 linking to Gnus.
16941 @item
16942 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
16943 work on a tty.
16944 @item
16945 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
16946 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
16947 @end itemize
16948
16949
16950 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Main Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
16951 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
16952 @include doclicense.texi
16953
16954
16955 @node Main Index, Key Index, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
16956 @unnumbered Concept index
16957
16958 @printindex cp
16959
16960 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
16961 @unnumbered Key index
16962
16963 @printindex ky
16964
16965 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
16966 @unnumbered Command and function index
16967
16968 @printindex fn
16969
16970 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
16971 @unnumbered Variable index
16972
16973 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
16974 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
16975 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
16976
16977 @printindex vr
16978
16979 @bye
16980
16981 @c Local variables:
16982 @c fill-column: 77
16983 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
16984 @c paragraph-start: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
16985 @c paragraph-separate: "\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
16986 @c End:
16987
16988
16989 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre